2006 Subaru Legacy 88532
2006 Subaru Legacy 88532
2006 Subaru Legacy 88532
1
2
3
4
000138
1) Legacy Sedan
2) Legacy Station wagon
3) OUTBACK Sedan
4) OUTBACK Station wagon
1
the climate control. This chapter informs you about Tire infor- NOTE
Chapter 5: Audio mation, Uniform tire quality grading stan- A NOTE gives information or sugges-
This chapter informs you how to operate dards and Reporting safety defects. tions how to make better use of your
your audio system. Chapter 14: Index vehicle.
Chapter 6: Interior equipment This is an alphabetical listing of all that’s in
This chapter informs you how to operate this manual. You can use it to quickly find
interior equipment. something you want to read. Safety symbol
Chapter 7: Starting and operating
This chapter informs you how to start and Safety warnings
operate your SUBARU.
Chapter 8: Driving tips You will find a number of WARNINGs,
This chapter informs you how to drive your CAUTIONs and NOTEs in this manual.
SUBARU in various conditions and ex- These safety warnings alert you to poten-
plains some safety tips on driving. tial hazards that could result in injury to
Chapter 9: In case of emergency you or others.
This chapter informs you what to do if you Please read these safety warnings as well
have a problem while driving, such as a as all other portions of this manual careful-
flat tire or engine overheating. ly in order to gain a better understanding
Chapter 10: Appearance care of how to use your SUBARU vehicle safe-
This chapter informs you how to keep your ly. 000013
SUBARU looking good. You will find a circle with a slash through it
Chapter 11: Maintenance and service in this manual. This symbol means “Do
This chapter informs you when you need not”, “Do not do this”, or “Do not let this
A WARNING indicates a situation in
to take your SUBARU to the dealer for happen”, depending upon the context.
which serious injury or death could
scheduled maintenance and informs you
result if the warning is ignored.
how to keep your SUBARU running prop-
erly.
Chapter 12: Specifications
This chapter informs you about dimension
A CAUTION indicates a situation in
and capacities of your SUBARU.
which injury or damage to your vehi-
Chapter 13: Consumer information and
cle, or both, could result if the cau-
Reporting safety defects
tion is ignored.
3
There are some of the symbols you may Child restraint top tether an- Engine hood
see on your vehicle. chorages
CAUTION
Fan speed
Windshield wiper deicer
Passengers’ windows lock
Instrument panel outlets
Wiper intermittent
Fuel Instrument panel outlets and
Windshield wiper and wash- foot outlets
er
Front fog lights Foot outlets
Rear window wiper and
washer Windshield defroster and
Parking lights foot outlets
Lights
Hazard warning flasher Windshield defroster
– CONTINUED –
4
Mark Name Safety precautions when y The SRS airbags deploy with con-
driving siderable speed and force. Occu-
pants who are out of proper posi-
Washer
Seatbelt and SRS airbag tion when the SRS airbag deploys
could suffer very serious injuries.
Door lock (Transmitter) Because the SRS airbag needs
enough space for deployment, the
y All persons in the vehicle should driver should always sit upright
Door unlock (Transmitter) fasten their seatbelts BEFORE the and well back in the seat as far
vehicle starts to move. Otherwise, from the steering wheel as practi-
Trunk lid (Sedan) or rear the possibility of serious injury cal while still maintaining full ve-
gate (Station wagon) (Trans- becomes greater in the event of a hicle control and the front passen-
mitter) sudden stop or accident. ger should move the seat as far
back as possible and sit upright
y To obtain maximum protection in and well back in the seat.
the event of an accident, the driv-
er and all passengers in the vehi- Carefully read the sections “Seat, seatbelt
cle should always wear seatbelts and SRS airbags” in chapter 1 of this own-
when the vehicle is moving. The er’s manual for instructions and precau-
SRS (Supplemental Restraint Sys- tions concerning the seatbelt system and
tem) airbag does not do away with SRS airbag system.
the need to fasten seatbelts. In
combination with the seatbelts, it
offers the best combined protec-
tion in case of a serious accident.
Not wearing a seatbelt increases
the chance of severe injury or
death in a crash even when the ve-
hicle has the SRS airbag.
5
Child safety y Put children aged 12 and under in y Always lock the passenger’s win-
the REAR seat properly restrained dows using the lock switch when
at all times in a child restraint de- children are riding in the vehicle.
vice or in a seatbelt. The SRS air- Failure to follow this procedure
y Never hold a child on your lap or bag deploys with considerable could result in injury to a child op-
in your arms while the vehicle is speed and force and can injure or erating the power window. Refer
moving. The passenger cannot even kill children, especially if to the “Power windows” section
protect the child from injury in a they are 12 years of age and under in chapter 2.
collision, because the child will be and are not restrained or improp-
caught between the passenger y Never leave unattended children
erly restrained. Because children in the vehicle. They could acci-
and objects inside the vehicle. are lighter and weaker than dentally injure themselves or oth-
y While riding in the vehicle, infants adults, their risk of being injured ers through inadvertent operation
and small children should always from deployment is greater. of the vehicle. Also, on hot or sun-
be placed in the REAR seat in an y NEVER INSTALL A REARWARD ny days, temperature in a closed
infant or child restraint system FACING CHILD SAFETY SEAT IN vehicle could quickly become
which is appropriate for the THE FRONT SEAT. DOING SO high enough to cause severe or
child’s age, height and weight. If a RISKS SERIOUS INJURY OR possibly fatal injuries to them.
child is too big for a child restraint DEATH TO THE CHILD BY PLAC-
system, the child should sit in the y Help prevent young children from
ING THE CHILD’S HEAD TOO locking themselves in the trunk.
REAR seat and be restrained us- CLOSE TO THE SRS AIRBAG.
ing the seatbelts. According to ac- When leaving the vehicle, either
cident statistics, children are saf- y Always use the child safety locks close all windows and lock all
er when properly restrained in the whenever a child rides in the rear doors or cancel the inside trunk
rear seating positions than in the seat. Serious injury could result if lid release. Also make certain that
front seating positions. Never al- a child accidentally opened the the trunk is closed. On hot or sun-
low a child to stand up or kneel on door and fell out. Refer to the ny days, the temperature in a
the seat. “Door locks” section in chapter 2. trunk could quickly become high
enough to cause death or serious
heat-related injuries including
brain damage to anyone locked
inside, particularly for small chil-
dren.
– CONTINUED –
6
Carefully read the sections “Child restraint y Avoid remaining in a parked vehi- Drinking and driving
systems”,“*SRS airbag (Supplemental cle for a lengthy time while the en-
Restraint System airbag)”, and “Seatbelts” gine is running. If that is unavoid-
in chapter 1 of this owner’s manual for in- able, then use the ventilation fan
structions and precautions concerning the to force fresh air into the vehicle. Drinking and then driving is very
child restraint system, seatbelt system dangerous. Alcohol in the blood-
and SRS airbag system. y Always keep the front ventilator
stream delays your reaction and im-
inlet grille free from snow, leaves
pairs your perception, judgment and
or other obstructions to ensure
Engine exhaust gas (carbon that the ventilation system always
attentiveness. If you drive after
monoxide) drinking – even if you drink just a lit-
works properly.
tle – it will increase the risk of being
y If at any time you suspect that ex- involved in a serious or fatal acci-
haust fumes are entering the vehi- dent, injuring or killing yourself,
cle, have the problem checked your passengers and others. In ad-
y Never inhale engine exhaust gas.
and corrected as soon as possi- dition, if you are injured in the acci-
Engine exhaust gas contains car-
ble. If you must drive under these dent, alcohol may increase the se-
bon monoxide, a colorless and
conditions, drive only with all win- verity of that injury.
odorless gas which is dangerous,
dows fully open.
or even lethal, if inhaled. Please don’t drink and drive.
y Keep the trunk lid or rear gate
y Always properly maintain the en- Drunken driving is one of the most fre-
closed while driving to prevent ex-
gine exhaust system to prevent quent causes of accidents. Since alcohol
haust gas from entering the vehi-
engine exhaust gas from entering affects all people differently, you may
cle.
the vehicle. have consumed too much alcohol to drive
y Never run the engine in a closed safely even if the level of alcohol in your
space, such as a garage, except blood is below the legal limit. The safest
for the brief time needed to drive thing you can do is never drink and drive.
the vehicle in or out of it. However if you have no choice but to
drive, stop drinking and sober up com-
pletely before getting behind the wheel.
7
Drugs and driving Driving when tired or sleepy Car phone/cell phone and
driving
There are some drugs (over the When you are tired or sleepy, your
counter and prescription) that can reaction will be delayed and your Do not use a car phone/cell phone
delay your reaction time and impair perception, judgment and attentive- while driving; it may distract your at-
your perception, judgment and at- ness will be impaired. If you drive tention from driving and can lead to
tentiveness. If you drive after taking when tired or sleepy, your, your pas- an accident. If you use a car phone/
them, it may increase your, your sengers’ and other persons’ chanc- cell phone, pull off the road and park
passengers’ and other persons’ risk es of being involved in a serious ac- in the a place before using your
of being involved in a serious or fa- cident may increase. phone. In some States/Provinces,
tal accident. only hands-free phones may legally
Please do not continue to drive but in-
be used while driving.
If you are taking any drugs, check with stead find a safe place to rest if you are
your doctor or pharmacist or read the liter- tired or sleepy. On long trips, you should
ature that accompanies the medication to make periodic rest stops to refresh your- Modification of your vehicle
determine if the drug you are taking can self before continuing on your journey.
impair your driving ability. Do not drive af- When possible, you should share the driv-
ter taking any medications that can make ing with others.
you drowsy or otherwise affect your ability Your vehicle should not be modi-
to safely operate a motor vehicle. If you fied. Modification could affect its
have a medical condition that requires you performance, safety or durability,
to take drugs, please consult with your and may even violate governmental
doctor. regulations. In addition, damage or
performance problems resulting
Never drive if you are under the influence from modification may not be cov-
of any illicit mind-altering drugs. For your ered under warranties.
own health and well-being, we urge you
not to take illegal drugs in the first place
and to seek treatment if you are addicted Driving with pets
to those drugs. Unrestrained pets can interfere with your
driving and distract your attention from
– CONTINUED –
8
driving. In a collision or sudden stop, unre- sure of each tire (including the spare) at
strained pets or cages can be thrown least once a month and before any long
around inside the vehicle and hurt you or journey.
your passengers. Besides, the pets can
be hurt under these situations. It is also for Check the tire pressure when the tires are
their own safety that pets should be prop- cold.
erly restrained in your vehicle. Restrain a Use a pressure gauge to adjust the tire
pet with a special traveling harness which pressures to the values shown on the tire
can be secured to the rear seat with a placard.
seatbelt or use a pet carrier which can be Refer to the “Tires and wheels” section in
secured to the rear seat by routing a seat- chapter 11 for detailed information.
belt through the carrier’s handle. Never re-
strain pets or pet carriers in the front pas- California proposition 65
senger’s seat. For further information, warning
consult your veterinarian, local animal
protection society or pet shop.
13 12 11 10 9 8 7
000139
11
4
5 6 8
9 5 7 8 4
000140
– CONTINUED –
12
5 4 3 000073
13
6 000177
– CONTINUED –
14
15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8
000047
15
14 13 12 11 10 9 000176
– CONTINUED –
16
Light control and wiper control levers/switches 1) Parking light switch (page 3-33)
2) Windshield wiper (page 3-34)
1 3) Mist (page 3-36)
4) Windshield washer (page 3-35)
5) Rear window wiper and washer
switch (page 3-37)
6) Wiper control lever (page 3-35)
7) Light control lever (page 3-31)
8) Fog light switch (page 3-34)
9) Headlight ON/OFF (page 3-31)
10 9 10) Headlight flasher High/Low beam
11 5 change (page 3-31)
11) Turn signal (page 3-32)
4
8 3
7 6
000074
17
8 7 6 5
000141
– CONTINUED –
18
8 7 6 5
000142
19
Warning and indicator light Mark Name Page Mark Name Page
– CONTINUED –
20
1
2 3
3 2
000147
21
Function settings
A SUBARU dealer can change the settings of the functions shown in the following table to meet your personal requirements. Contact
the nearest SUBARU dealer for details. If your vehicle is equipped with navigation system, the settings for some of these functions can
be changed using the monitor. For details, please refer to the Owner’s Manual supplement for the monitor.
Monitoring start delay time (after closure of 0 second / 30 seconds 30 seconds 2-16
doors)
Remote keyless entry system Hazard warning flasher Operation / Non-operation Operation 2-7
Key lock-in prevention Key lock-in prevention Operation / Non-operation Operation 2-6
Rear window defogger Rear window defogger Operation for 15 min. / Continuous opera- Operation for 3-38
tion 15 min.
Windshield wiper deicer (if Windshield wiper deicer Operation for 15 min. / Continuous opera- Operation for 3-38
equipped) tion 15 min.
Dome light Operation in interlock with remote keyless OFF / Short / Normal / Long Normal 6-2
entry system
Battery drainage prevention func- Battery drainage prevention function Operation / Non-operation Operation 2-6
tion
Seat, seatbelt and SRS airbags
Front seats .......................................................... 1-2 Installing child restraint systems with A/ELR 1
Manual seat ............................................................. 1-3 seatbelt .................................................................. 1-28
Power seat (if equipped) ........................................ 1-4 Installing a booster seat ......................................... 1-31
Reclining the seatback ........................................... 1-4 Installation of child restraint systems by use of
Head restraint adjustment ..................................... 1-5 lower and tether anchorages (LATCH) ............... 1-32
Active head restraint .............................................. 1-6 Top tether anchorages ........................................... 1-36
Lumbar support (if equipped) ................................ 1-6 *SRS airbag (Supplemental Restraint System
Seat heater (if equipped) ................................... 1-7 airbag) .............................................................. 1-38
Rear seats ........................................................... 1-7 Vehicle with SRS airbags and lap/shoulder
Folding down the rear seat – Station wagon ....... 1-8 restraints for driver, front passenger, and
Head restraint adjustment ..................................... 1-8 window-side rear passengers ............................. 1-38
Subaru advanced frontal airbag system .............. 1-43
Armrest (if equipped) ......................................... 1-10 SRS side airbag and SRS curtain airbag .............. 1-53
Loading long objects (Sedan) ............................... 1-10 SRS airbag system monitors ................................. 1-59
Seatbelts ............................................................. 1-11 SRS airbag system servicing ................................ 1-60
Seatbelt safety tips ................................................. 1-11 Precautions against vehicle modification ............ 1-61
Emergency Locking Retractor (ELR) .................... 1-12
Automatic/Emergency Locking Retractor
(A/ELR) .................................................................. 1-13
Seatbelt warning light and chime .......................... 1-13
Fastening the seatbelt ............................................ 1-15
Seatbelt maintenance ............................................. 1-21
Front seatbelt pretensioners ............................. 1-21
System monitors .................................................... 1-22
System servicing .................................................... 1-23
Precautions against vehicle modification ............ 1-24
Child restraint systems ..................................... 1-25
Where to place a child restraint system ............... 1-26
Choosing a child restraint system ........................ 1-27
1-2 Seat, seatbelt and SRS airbags
Front seats
Seat, seatbelt and SRS airbags
NEVER INSTALL A REARWARD Pull the lever upward and slide the seat to
FACING CHILD SEAT IN THE FRONT the desired position. Then release the le-
SEAT. DOING SO RISKS SERIOUS ver and move the seat back and forth to To prevent the passenger from slid-
INJURY OR DEATH TO THE CHILD make sure that it is securely locked into ing under the seatbelt in the event of
BY PLACING THE CHILD’S HEAD place. a collision, always put the seatback
TOO CLOSE TO THE SRS AIRBAG. T Reclining the seatback in the upright position while the ve-
According to accident statistics, hicle is in motion. Also, do not place
children are safer when properly re- objects such as cushions between
strained in the rear seating posi- the passenger and the seatback. If
tions than in the front seating posi- you do so, the risk of sliding under
tions. For instructions and precau- the lap belt and of the lap belt sliding
tions concerning child restraint sys- up over the abdomen will increase,
tems, see the “Child restraint sys- and both can result in serious inter-
tems” section in this chapter. nal injury or death.
Manual seat
T Fore and aft adjustment
100085
100245
The seatback placed in a reclined position Power seat (if equipped) Reclining the seatback
can spring back upward with force when
released. When operating the reclining le- T Fore and aft adjustment
ver to return the seatback, hold it lightly so
that it may be raised back gradually.
T Seat cushion height adjustment
(driver’s seat)
100085
100247
or push down the front end of the control Head restraint adjustment
switch.
T Seat height adjustment (Driver’s
seat only)
100250
Seat heater (if equipped) When the vehicle’s interior is warmed Rear seats
enough or before you leave the vehicle,
be sure to turn the switch off.
The head restraint is not intended to The head restraint is not intended to
be used at the lowest position. Be- be used at the lowest position. Be-
fore sitting on the seat, raise the fore sitting on the seat, raise the
head restraint to an appropriate po- head restraint to an appropriate po-
sition depending on your sitting sition depending on your sitting
height. height.
200284
Station wagon
head restraint to improve rearward visibil- Armrest (if equipped) To lower the armrest, pull on the top edge
ity. of the armrest.
200291
Sedan
200292
– CONTINUED –
1-12 Seat, seatbelt and SRS airbags
NEVER INSTALL A REARWARD tem, the child should sit in the rear seat T Expectant mothers
FACING CHILD SEAT IN THE and be restrained using the seatbelts. Ac-
FRONT SEAT. DOING SO RISKS cording to accident statistics, children are
SERIOUS INJURY OR DEATH TO safer when properly restrained in the rear
THE CHILD BY PLACING THE seating positions than in the front seating
CHILD’S HEAD TOO CLOSE TO positions. Never allow a child to stand up
THE SRS AIRBAG. or kneel on the seat.
According to accident statistics, If the shoulder portion of the belt crosses
children are safer when properly the face or neck, adjust the shoulder belt
restrained in the rear seating posi- anchor height (window-side seating posi-
tions than in the front seating po- tions only) and then if necessary move the
sitions. For instructions and pre- child closer to the belt buckle to help pro-
cautions concerning the child re- vide a good shoulder belt fit. Care must be 100100
straint system, see the “Child re- taken to securely place the lap belt as low
straint systems” section in this as possible on the hips and not on the Expectant mothers also need to use the
chapter. child’s waist. If the shoulder portion of the seatbelts. They should consult their doctor
belt cannot be properly positioned, a child for specific recommendations. The lap
Your vehicle is equipped with a crash restraint system should be used. Never belt should be worn securely and as low
sensing and diagnostic module, which will place the shoulder belt under the child’s as possible over the hips, not over the
record the use of the seatbelt(s) by the arm or behind the child’s back. waist.
driver and front passenger when any of
the SRS frontal, side and curtain airbags
deploys.
Emergency Locking Retrac-
tor (ELR)
T Infants or small children The driver’s seatbelt has an Emergency
Use a child restraint system that is suit- Locking Retractor (ELR).
able for your vehicle. See information on The emergency locking retractor allows
“Child restraint systems” section in this normal body movement but the retractor
chapter. locks automatically during a sudden stop,
T Children impact or if you pull the belt very quickly
out of the retractor.
If a child is too big for a child restraint sys-
Seat, seatbelt and SRS airbags 1-13
switch), the warning lights will alternate warning after turning ON the ignition again. For adjusting procedure, refer to
between flashing and steady illumination switch by unfastening and refastening the “Manual seat” in the front seats sec-
at 15-second intervals, and the chime will the driver’s seatbelt. When the ignition tion in Chapter 1 in this owner’s manual.
sound while the warning light(s) is/are switch is turned ON next time, howev- (Models equipped with manual seats only)
flashing. er, the complete sequence of the warn-
Alternate flashing and steady illumination ing operation resumes. For further de- If the seatbelt warning device for the front
of the warning lights and sounding of the tails about canceling the warning oper- passenger’s seat does not function cor-
chime will continue until both driver and ation, please contact your SUBARU rectly (e.g., it is activated even when the
front passenger fasten their seatbelts. dealer. front passenger’s seat is empty or it is de-
activated even when the front passenger
NOTE If there is no passenger on the front pas- has not fastened his/her seatbelt), take
y If the driver and/or front passenger senger’s seat, the seatbelt warning device the following actions.
unfasten(s) the seatbelt(s) after fasten- for the front passenger’s seat will be deac- y Ensure that no article is placed on the
ing, the seatbelt warning device oper- tivated. The front passenger’s occupant seat other than a child restraint system
ates as follows according to the vehi- detection system monitors whether or not and the child occupant.
cle speed. there is a passenger on the front passen- y Ensure that there is no article left in the
y At speeds lower than approximate- ger’s seat. seatback pocket.
ly 9 mph (15 km/h) Observe the following precautions. Failure y Ensure that the backward-forward posi-
The warning light(s) for unfastened to do so may prevent the device from func- tion and seatback of front passenger’s
seatbelt(s) will alternate between tioning correctly or cause the device to seat are locked into place securely by
flashing and steady illumination at fail. moving the seat back and forth. (Models
15-second intervals. The chime will y Do not install any accessory such as a equipped with manual seats only)
not sound. table or TV onto the seatback.
y At speeds higher than approxi- y Do not store a heavy load in the seat- If the seatbelt warning device for front
mately 9 mph (15 km/h) back pocket. passenger’s seat still does not function
y Do not allow the rear seat occupant to correctly after taking relevant corrective
The warning light(s) for unfastened
seatbelt(s) will alternate between place his/her hands or legs on the front actions described above, immediately
flashing and steady illumination at passenger’s seatback, or allow him/her to contact your SUBARU dealer for an in-
pull the seatback. spection.
15-second intervals and the chime
will sound while the warning light(s) y Do not use front seats with their back-
is/are flashing. ward-forward position and seatback not
y It is possible to cancel the warning being locked into place securely. If any of
operation that follows the 6-second them are not locked securely, adjust them
Seat, seatbelt and SRS airbags 1-15
– CONTINUED –
1-16 Seat, seatbelt and SRS airbags
T Rear seatbelts (except rear center Push the button on the buckle.
seatbelt on Station wagon)
Before closing the door, make sure that
1. Sit well back in the seat. the belts are retracted properly to avoid
2. Pick up the tongue plate and pull the catching the belt webbing in the door.
belt out slowly. Do not let it get twisted. If
the belt stops before reaching the buckle, T Rear center seatbelt on Station wag-
return the belt slightly and pull it out more on model
slowly. If the belt still cannot be unlocked,
let the belt retract slightly after giving a
strong pull on it, then pull it out slowly
again. 1
100103 4
2
4. To make the lap part tight, pull up on
the shoulder belt.
5. Place the lap belt as low as possible on
your hips, not on your waist.
3
V Unfastening the seatbelt
100651
100105
– CONTINUED –
1-18 Seat, seatbelt and SRS airbags
100735 100114
2. Pull out the seatbelt slowly from the 5. Insert the center seatbelt tongue plate
overhead retractor. in the center seatbelt buckle marked
“CENTER” on the left-hand side until it
clicks.
200298
100309
waist.
V Unfastening the seatbelt
100381 200300
100382
100121
y Keep the belts free of polishes,
y Do not allow the retractor to roll oils, chemicals and particularly The driver’s and front passenger’s seat-
up the seatbelt too quickly. Other- battery acid. belts have a seatbelt pretensioner. The
wise, the metal tongue plates may seatbelt pretensioners are designed to be
hit against the trim, resulting in y Never attempt to make modifica- activated in the event of an accident in-
damaged trim. tions or changes that will prevent volving a moderate to severe frontal colli-
the seatbelt from operating prop- sion.
y Have the seatbelt fully rolled up erly.
so that the tongue plates are neat- The pretensioner sensor also serves as a
ly stored. A hanging tongue plate SRS frontal airbag sensor. If the sensor
can swing and hit against the trim detects a certain predetermined amount
during driving, causing damage to of force during a frontal collision, the front
the trim. seatbelt is quickly drawn back in by the re-
tractor to take up the slack so that the belt
more effectively restrains the front seat
occupant.
When a seatbelt pretensioner is activated,
– CONTINUED –
1-22 Seat, seatbelt and SRS airbags
an operating noise will be heard and a soon as possible. y When discarding front seatbelt re-
small amount of smoke will be released. y If the front seatbelt retractor assem- tractor assemblies or scrapping
These occurrences are normal and not bly or surrounding area has been dam- the entire vehicle due to collision
harmful. This smoke does not indicate a aged, contact your SUBARU dealer as damage or for other reasons, con-
fire in the vehicle. soon as possible. sult your SUBARU dealer.
y When you sell your vehicle, we urge
Once the seatbelt pretensioner has been you to explain to the buyer that it has
activated, the seatbelt retractor remains seatbelt pretensioners by alerting him System monitors
locked. Consequently, the seatbelt can to the contents of this section.
not be pulled out and retracted and there-
fore must be replaced.
NOTE
y Seatbelt pretensioners are not de- y To obtain maximum protection,
signed to activate in minor frontal im- occupants should sit in an upright
pacts, in side or rear impacts or in roll- position with their seatbelts prop-
over accidents. erly fastened. Refer to “Seatbelts”
y The driver’s seat and passenger’s section in this chapter.
seat pretensioners and frontal airbag y Do not modify, remove or strike
operate simultaneously. the front seatbelt retractor assem-
y Pretensioners are designed to func- blies or surrounding area. This 200326
tion on a one-time-only basis. In the could result in accidental activa-
event that a pretensioner is activated, tion of the seatbelt pretensioners SRS airbag system warning light
both the driver’s and front passenger’s or could make the system inoper-
seatbelt retractor assemblies must be ative, possibly resulting in seri- A diagnostic system continually monitors
replaced and only by an authorized ous injury. Seatbelt pretensioners the readiness of the seatbelt pretensioner
SUBARU dealer. When replacing seat- have no user-serviceable parts. while the vehicle is being driven. The seat-
belt retractor assemblies, use only For required servicing of front belt pretensioners share the control mod-
genuine SUBARU parts. seatbelt retractors equipped with ule with the airbag system. Therefore, if
y If either front seatbelt does not re- seatbelt pretensioners, see your any malfunction occurs in a seatbelt pre-
tract or cannot be pulled out due to a nearest SUBARU dealer. tensioner, the SRS airbag system warning
malfunction or activation of the preten- light will illuminate. The SRS airbag sys-
sioner, contact your SUBARU dealer as tem warning light will show normal system
Seat, seatbelt and SRS airbags 1-23
operation by lighting for approximately 6 y Front passenger’s seatbelt tension sen- y Continuous illumination of the
seconds when the ignition switch is turned sor warning light
to the “ON” position. y Front passenger’s occupant detection
system weight sensor y Illumination of the warning light
The following components are monitored y Front passenger’s occupant detection while driving
by the indicator: control module
y Front sub sensor (Right-hand side) y Front passenger’s frontal airbag ON System servicing
y Front sub sensor (Left-hand side) and OFF indicator
y Airbag control module (including impact y All related wiring
sensors)
y Frontal airbag module (Driver’s side) y When discarding a seatbelt retrac-
y Frontal airbag module (Front passen- tor assembly or scrapping the en-
ger’s side) If the warning light exhibits any of tire vehicle damaged by a colli-
y Side airbag sensor (Center pillar right- the following conditions, there may sion, consult your SUBARU deal-
hand side) be a malfunction in the seatbelt pre- er.
y Side airbag sensor (Center pillar left- tensioners and/or SRS airbag sys-
hand side) tem. Immediately take your vehicle
y Side airbag module (Driver’s side) to your nearest SUBARU dealer to
y Side airbag module (Front passenger’s have the system checked. Unless
side) checked and properly repaired, the
y Curtain airbag sensor (Rear wheel seatbelt pretensioners and/or SRS
house right-hand side) airbags will operate improperly (e.g.
y Curtain airbag sensor (Rear wheel SRS airbags may inflate in a very mi-
house left-hand side) nor collision or not inflate in a se-
y Curtain airbag module (Right side) vere collision), which may increase
y Curtain airbag module (Left side) the risk of injury.
y Seatbelt pretensioner (Driver’s side)
y Seatbelt pretensioner (Front passen- y Flashing or flickering of the warn-
ger’s side) ing light
y Seatbelt buckle switch (Driver’s side) y No illumination of the warning
y Seatbelt buckle switch (Front passen- light when the ignition switch is
ger’s side) first turned to the “ON” position
y Driver’s seat position sensor
– CONTINUED –
1-24 Seat, seatbelt and SRS airbags
– CONTINUED –
1-26 Seat, seatbelt and SRS airbags
Where to place a child re- Some types of child restraints might not
straint system be able to be secured firmly due to projec-
Children should be properly re- tion of the seat cushion.
The following are SUBARU’s recommen- In this seating position, you should use
strained at all times. Never allow a dations on where to place a child restraint
child to stand up, or to kneel on any only a child restraint system that has a
system in your vehicle. bottom base that fits snugly against the
seat. Unrestrained children will be
thrown forward during sudden stop contours of the seat cushion and can be
or in an accident and can be injured securely retained using the seatbelt.
seriously. C: Rear seat, center seating position
Additionally, children standing up Installing a child restraint system is not
or kneeling on or in front of the front recommended, although the A/ELR seat-
seat are exposed another serious belt and an upper anchorage (tether an-
danger. Since the SRS airbag de- chorage) are provided in this position.
ploys with considerable speed and Some types of child restraints might not
force, the child could be injured or be able to be secured firmly due to projec-
even killed. tion of the seat cushion.
In this seating position, you should use
100127
only a child restraint system that has a
A: Front passenger’s seat bottom base that fits snugly against the
You should not install a child restraint sys- contours of the seat cushion and can be
tem (including a booster seat) due to the securely retained using the seatbelt.
hazard to children posed by the passen-
ger’s airbag.
B: Rear seat, window-side seating po-
sitions
Recommended positions for all types of
child restraint systems.
In these positions, Automatic/Emergency
Locking Retractor (A/ELR) seatbelts and
lower anchorages (bars) are provided for
installing a child restraint system.
Seat, seatbelt and SRS airbags 1-27
– CONTINUED –
1-28 Seat, seatbelt and SRS airbags
Installing child restraint sys- ing the instructions provided by its manu-
tems with A/ELR seatbelt facturer.
When you install a child restraint 3. Insert the tongue plate into the buckle
system, follow the manufacturer’s until you hear a click.
instructions supplied with it. After
y Child restraint systems and seat- installing the child restraint system,
belts can become hot in a vehicle check to ensure that it is held se-
that has been closed up in sunny curely in position. If it is not held
weather; they could burn a small tight and secure, the danger of your
child. Check the child restraint child suffering personal injury in the
system before you place a child in event of an accident may be in-
it. creased.
y Do not leave an unsecured child T Installing a rearward facing child re-
restraint system in your vehicle. straint
Unsecured child restraint sys-
tems can be thrown around inside 100504
of the vehicle in a sudden stop,
turn or accident; they can strike 4. Take up the slack in the lap belt.
and injure vehicle occupants as 5. Pull out the seatbelt fully from the re-
well as result in serious injuries or tractor to change the retractor over from
death to the child. the Emergency Locking Retractor (ELR)
to the Automatic Locking Retractor (ALR)
function. Then, allow the belt to rewind
into the retractor. As the belt is rewinding,
clicks will be heard which indicate the re-
tractor functions as ALR.
100503
100505 100506
6. Push and pull the child restraint system 8. To remove the child restraint system,
forward and from side to side to check if it press the release button on the seatbelt
is firmly secured. buckle and allow the belt to retract com-
Sometimes a child restraint can be more pletely. The belt will return to the ELR
firmly secured by pushing it down into the mode. 100136
seat cushion and then tightening the seat-
belt. 1. Place the child restraint system in the
7. Pull at the shoulder portion of the belt seating position.
to confirm that it cannot be pulled out (ALR NEVER INSTALL A REARWARD 2. Run the lap and shoulder belt through
properly functioning). FACING CHILD SEAT IN THE FRONT or around the child restraint system follow-
PASSENGER’S SEAT. DOING SO ing the instructions provided by its manu-
RISKS SERIOUS INJURY OR DEATH facturer.
TO THE CHILD BY PLACING THE 3. Insert the tongue plate into the buckle
CHILD’S HEAD TOO CLOSE TO THE until you hear a click.
SRS AIRBAG.
NOTE
When the child restraint system is no
longer in use, remove it and restore the
– CONTINUED –
1-30 Seat, seatbelt and SRS airbags
4. Take up the slack in the lap belt. 6. Before having a child sit in the child re- Sedan
5. Pull out the seatbelt fully from the re- straint system, move it back and forth and
tractor to change the retractor over from right and left to check if it is firmly secured.
the Emergency Locking Retractor (ELR) Sometimes a child restraint can be more
to the Automatic Locking Retractor (ALR) firmly secured by pushing it down into the
function. Then, allow the belt to rewind seat cushion and then tightening the seat-
into the retractor. As the belt is rewinding, belt.
clicks will be heard which indicate the re- 7. Pull at the shoulder portion of the belt
tractor functions as ALR. to confirm that it cannot be pulled out (ALR
properly functioning).
100263
Station wagon
er anchor and tighten the top tether. See Installing a booster seat
the “Top tether anchorages” for additional
instructions. When you install a child restraint
system, follow the manufacturer’s
y Child restraint systems and seat- instructions supplied with it. After
belts can become hot in a vehicle installing the child restraint system,
that has been closed up in sunny check to ensure that it is held se-
weather; they could burn a small curely in position. If it is not held
child. Check the child restraint tight and secure, the danger of your
system before you place a child in child suffering personal injury in the
it. event of an accident may be in-
y Do not leave an unsecured child creased.
restraint system in your vehicle.
Unsecured child restraint sys-
100140 tems can be thrown around inside
of the vehicle in a sudden stop,
9. To remove the child restraint system, turn or accident; they can strike
press the release button on the seatbelt and injure vehicle occupants as
buckle and allow the belt to retract com- well as result in serious injuries or
pletely. The belt will return to the ELR death to the child.
mode.
NOTE
When the child restraint system is no
longer in use, remove it and restore the 100141
ELR function of the retractor. That
function is restored by allowing the 1. Place the booster seat in the rear seat-
seatbelt to retract fully. ing position and sit the child on it. The
child should sit well back on the booster
seat.
2. Run the lap and shoulder belt through
or around the booster seat and the child
– CONTINUED –
1-32 Seat, seatbelt and SRS airbags
following the instructions provided by its y Never place the shoulder belt un- Installation of child restraint
manufacturer. der the child’s arm or behind the systems by use of lower and
3. Insert the tongue plate into the buckle child’s back. If an accident oc-
until you hear a click. Take care not to
tether anchorages (LATCH)
curs, this can increase the risk or
twist the seatbelt. severity of injury to the child.
Make sure the shoulder belt is positioned
across the center of child’s shoulder and y The seatbelt should fit snugly in
order to provide full restraint. y Child restraint systems and seat-
that the lap belt is positioned as low as
Loose fitting belts are not as ef- belts can become hot in a vehicle
possible on the child’s hips.
fective in preventing or reducing that has been closed up in sunny
injury. weather; they could burn a small
child. Check the child restraint
y Place the lap belt as low as possi-
system before you place a child in
ble on the child’s hips. A high-po-
it.
sitioned lap belt will increase the
risk of sliding under the lap belt y Do not leave an unsecured child
and of the lap belt sliding up over restraint system in your vehicle.
the abdomen, and both can result Unsecured child restraint sys-
in serious internal injury or death. tems can be thrown around inside
of the vehicle in a sudden stop,
y Make sure the shoulder belt is po-
turn or accident; they can strike
sitioned across the center of
and injure vehicle occupants as
100142 child’s shoulder. Placing the
well as result in serious injuries or
shoulder belt over the neck may
4. To remove the booster seat, press the death to the child.
result in neck injury during sud-
release button on the seatbelt buckle and den braking or in a collision.
allow the belt to retract.
Some types of child restraint systems can Your vehicle is equipped with four lower
be installed on the rear seat of your vehi- anchorages (bars) and three upper an-
cle without use of the seatbelts. Such child chorages (tether anchorages) for accom-
restraint systems are secured to the dedi- modating such child restraint systems. 100268
cated anchorages provided on the vehicle
body. Sedan
The lower and tether anchorages are
sometimes referred to as the LATCH sys-
tem (Lower Anchors and Tethers for CHil-
dren).
100311
100654
Station wagon
100519
You will find marks “ ” at the bottom of
the rear seat seatbacks. These marks in- 1. Sedan: Make the clearance between
Seat, seatbelt and SRS airbags 1-35
100520 100656
2. While following the instructions sup- 3. [If your child restraint system is of a
plied by the child restraint system manu- flexible attachment type (which uses teth-
100655 facturer, connect the lower hooks onto the er belts to connect the child restraint sys-
lower anchorages located at “ ” marks tem properly to the lower anchorages)]
Station wagon: Remove the two covers on the bottom of the rear seatback. When While pushing the child restraint into the
from the selected side of the rear seat- the hooks are connected, make sure the seat cushion, pull both left and right lower
back to expose the anchorages (bars) to adjacent seatbelts are not caught. tether belts up to secure the child restraint
be used for installation of the child re- system firmly by taking up the slack in the
straint system. belt.
4. Connect the top tether hook to the teth-
er anchorage and firmly tighten the tether.
For information on how to set the top teth-
er, read the following “Top tether anchor-
ages”.
– CONTINUED –
1-36 Seat, seatbelt and SRS airbags
100269
5. Before seating a child in the child re-
straint system, try to move seat back and Three tether anchorages, i.e., ones for the
forth and left and right to verify that it is TOP TETHER right, center and left positions, are already
held securely in position. installed on the rear edge of the roof.
6. To remove the child restraint system, Open the cover flap to use each anchor-
follow the reverse procedures of installa- age.
tion.
If you have any question concerning this
type of child restraint system, ask your
SUBARU dealer.
100268
200310 100270
3. Fasten the top tether hook of the child 1. Remove the head restraint at the seat-
restraint system to the appropriate upper ing position where the child restraint sys-
anchorage. tem has been installed with the seatbelt or
4. Tighten the top tether securely.
– CONTINUED –
1-38 Seat, seatbelt and SRS airbags
senger, and window-side rear passen- For instructions and precautions y The SRS airbags deploy with con-
gers) concerning the seatbelt system, siderable speed and force. Occu-
These SRS airbags are designed only see the “Seatbelts” section in this pants who are out of proper posi-
as a supplement to the primary protec- chapter. tion when the SRS airbag deploys
tion provided by the seatbelt. y Do not sit or lean unnecessarily could suffer very serious injuries.
close to the SRS airbag. Because Because the SRS airbag needs
The system also controls front seatbelt the SRS airbag deploys with con- enough space for deployment, the
pretensioners. For operation instructions siderable speed – faster than the driver should always sit upright
and precautions concerning the seatbelt blink of an eye – and force to pro- and well back in the seat as far
pretensioner, see the “Front seatbelt pre- tect in high speed collisions, the from the steering wheel as practi-
tensioners” section in this chapter. force of an airbag can injure an cal while still maintaining full ve-
occupant whose body is too close hicle control and the front passen-
to SRS airbag. ger should move the seat as far
back as possible and sit upright
y To obtain maximum protection in It is also important to wear your and well back in the seat.
the event of an accident, the driv- seatbelt to help avoid injuries that
can result when the SRS airbag y Do not place any objects over or
er and all passengers in the vehi-
cle should always wear seatbelts contacts an occupant not in prop- near the SRS airbag cover or be-
when the vehicle is moving. The er position such as one thrown tween you and the SRS airbag. If
SRS airbag is designed only as a forward during pre-accident brak- the SRS airbag deploys, those ob-
supplement to the primary protec- ing. jects could interfere with its prop-
tion provided by the seatbelt. It er operation and could be pro-
Even when properly positioned, pelled inside the vehicle and
does not do away with the need to there remains a possibility that an
fasten seatbelts. In combination cause injury.
occupant may suffer minor injury
with the seatbelts, it offers the such as abrasions and bruises to
best combined protection in case the face or arms because of the
of a serious accident. SRS airbag deployment force.
Not wearing a seatbelt increases
the chance of severe injury or
death in a crash even when the ve-
hicle has the SRS airbag.
– CONTINUED –
1-40 Seat, seatbelt and SRS airbags
– CONTINUED –
1-42 Seat, seatbelt and SRS airbags
Subaru advanced frontal air- The driver’s SRS frontal airbag is stowed
bag system in the center portion of the steering wheel.
The front passenger’s SRS frontal airbag NEVER INSTALL A REARWARD
Your vehicle is equipped with a Subaru is stowed near the top of the dashboard
advanced frontal airbag system that com- FACING CHILD SAFETY SEAT IN
under an “SRS AIRBAG” mark. THE FRONT SEAT. DOING SO
plies with the new advanced frontal airbag
requirements in the amended Federal Mo- In a moderate to severe frontal collision, RISKS SERIOUS INJURY OR DEATH
tor Vehicle Safety Standard (FMVSS) No. the driver’s and front passenger’s SRS TO THE CHILD BY PLACING THE
208. frontal airbags deploy and supplement the CHILD’S HEAD TOO CLOSE TO THE
The Subaru advanced frontal airbag sys- seatbelts by reducing the impact on the SRS AIRBAG.
tem automatically determines the deploy- driver’s and front passenger’s head and
ment force of the driver’s SRS frontal air- chest.
bag at the time of deployment as well as
whether or not to activate the front pas-
senger’s SRS frontal airbag and, if activat-
ed, the deployment force of the SRS fron-
tal airbag at the time of deployment.
Your vehicle has warning labels on the
driver’s and front passenger’s sun visors
beginning with the phrase “EVEN WITH
ADVANCED AIR BAGS” and a tag at-
tached to the glove box lid beginning with
the phrase “Even with Advanced Air 100126
Bags”. Make sure that you carefully read
100261
the instructions on the warning labels and
tag.
Always wear your seatbelt. The subaru Never allow a child to stand up, or to
advanced frontal airbag system is a sup- kneel on the front passenger’s seat.
plemental restraint system and must be The SRS airbag deploys with con-
used in combination with a seatbelt. All siderable force and can injure or
occupants should wear a seatbelt or be even kill the child.
seated in an appropriate child restraint
system.
– CONTINUED –
1-44 Seat, seatbelt and SRS airbags
100125 100155
Never hold a child on your lap or in The SRS airbag deploys with con-
your arms. The SRS airbag deploys siderable speed and force. Occu-
with considerable force and can in- pants who are out of proper position
jure or even kill the child. when the SRS airbag deploys could
suffer very serious injuries. Be- 100274
cause the SRS airbag needs enough
space for deployment, the driver
should always sit upright and well
back in the seat as far from the Do not put any objects over the
steering wheel as practical while steering wheel pad and dashboard.
still maintaining full vehicle control If the SRS frontal airbag deploys,
and the front passenger should those objects could interfere with its
move the seat as far back as possi- proper operation and could be pro-
ble and sit upright and well back in pelled inside the vehicle and cause
the seat. injury.
Seat, seatbelt and SRS airbags 1-45
– CONTINUED –
1-46 Seat, seatbelt and SRS airbags
y Do not apply any strong impact to the ing light will illuminate. Have the system bag ON indicator
front passenger’s seat such as by kicking. inspected by your SUBARU dealer imme- or : Front passenger’s frontal air-
y Do not spill liquid on the front passen- diately if the SRS airbag system warning bag OFF indicator
ger’s seat. If liquid is spilled, wipe it off im- light comes on. The front passenger’s frontal airbag ON
mediately. If your vehicle has sustained impact, this and OFF indicators show you the status of
y Do not disassemble the front passen- may affect the proper function of the the front passenger’s SRS frontal airbag.
ger’s seat. Subaru advanced frontal airbag system. The indicators are located between the
y Do not install any accessory (such as Have your vehicle inspected at your map lights.
an audio amplifier) other than a genuine SUBARU dealer. When the ignition switch is turned to the
SUBARU accessory under the front pas- “ON” position, both the ON and OFF indi-
senger’s seat. NOTE
The front passenger’s SRS side airbag, cators illuminate for 6 seconds during
y Do not place anything (shoes, umbrella, which time the system is checked. Follow-
etc.) under the front passenger’s seat. SRS curtain airbag and seatbelt preten-
sioner are not controlled by the Subaru ing the system check, both indicators ex-
y The front passenger’s seat must not be tinguish for 2 seconds. After that, one of
used with the head restraint removed. advanced frontal airbag system.
the indicators illuminates depending on
y Do not leave any article including a child T Passenger’s frontal airbag ON and the status of the front passenger’s SRS
restraint system on the front passenger’s OFF indicators frontal airbag determined by the Subaru
seat or the seatbelt tongue and buckle en- advanced frontal airbag system monitor-
gaged when you leave your vehicle. ing.
y Do not place a magnet near the seatbelt If the front passenger’s SRS frontal airbag
buckle and the seatbelt retractor. is activated, the passenger’s frontal airbag
y Do not use front seats with their back- ON indicator will illuminate while the OFF
ward-forward position and seatback not indicator will remain extinguished.
being locked into place securely. If any of If the front passenger’s SRS frontal airbag
them are not locked securely, adjust them is deactivated, the passenger’s frontal air-
again. For adjusting procedure, refer to bag ON indicator will remain extinguished
the “Manual seat” in the front seats sec- while the OFF indicator will illuminate.
tion in Chapter 1 in this owner’s manual. If both the ON and OFF indicators remain
(Models equipped with manual seats only) lit or extinguished simultaneously, the sys-
100663
If the seatbelt buckle switch and/or front tem is faulty. Contact your SUBARU deal-
passenger’s occupant detection system or : Front passenger’s frontal air- er immediately for an inspection.
have failed, the SRS airbag system warn-
Seat, seatbelt and SRS airbags 1-47
T Conditions in which front passen- y Do not place more than one child on the
ger’s SRS frontal airbag is not acti- seat.
vated NEVER INSTALL A REARWARD y Do not install any accessory such as a
The front passenger’s SRS frontal airbag FACING CHILD SEAT IN THE FRONT table or TV onto the seatback.
will not be activated when any of the fol- PASSENGER’S SEAT EVEN IF THE y Do not store a heavy load in the seat-
lowing conditions are met regarding the FRONT PASSENGER’S SRS FRON- back pocket.
front passenger’s seat: TAL AIRBAG IS DEACTIVATED. Be y Do not allow the rear seat occupant to
y The seat is empty. sure to install it in the REAR seat in place his/her hands or legs on the front
y The seat is equipped with a rearward a correct manner. Also, it is strongly passenger’s seatback, or allow him/her to
facing child restraint system and an infant recommended that any forward fac- pull the seatback.
is restrained with it. (See WARNING that ing child seat or booster seat be in- V If the front passenger’s frontal air-
follows.) stalled in the REAR seat, and that bag ON indicator illuminates and the
y The seat is equipped with a forward fac- even children who have outgrown a OFF indicator extinguishes even
ing child restraint system and a small child child restraint system be also seat- when an infant or a small child is in
is restrained with it. (See WARNING that ed in the REAR seat. This is because a child restraint system (including
follows.) children sitting in the front passen- booster seat)
y The seat is equipped with a booster ger’s seat may be killed or severely
seat and a small child is in the booster Turn the ignition switch to the “OFF” posi-
injured should the front passenger’s
seat. (See WARNING that follows.) tion if the front passenger’s frontal airbag
SRS frontal airbag deploy. REAR
y The seat is relieved of the occupant ON indicator illuminates and the OFF indi-
seats are the safest place for chil-
load for a time exceeding the predeter- cator extinguishes even when an infant or
dren.
mined monitoring time period. a small child is in a child restraint system
y The seat is occupied by a child who has When the front passenger’s seat is occu- (including booster seat). Remove the child
outgrown a child restraint system (See pied by a child, observe the following pre- restraint system from the seat. By refer-
WARNING that follows.) or by a small cautions. Failure to do so may increase ring to the child restraint manufacturer’s
adult. the load on the front passenger’s seat, ac- recommendations as well as the child re-
y The front passenger’s occupant detec- tivating the front passenger’s SRS frontal straint system installation procedures in
tion system is faulty. airbag even though that seat is occupied the “Child restraint systems” section in this
by a child. chapter, correctly install the child restraint
y Do not place any article on the seat oth- system. Turn the ignition switch to the
er than the child occupant and a child re- “ON” position and make sure that the front
straint system. passenger’s frontal airbag ON indicator
– CONTINUED –
1-48 Seat, seatbelt and SRS airbags
goes out and the OFF indicator comes on. cator illuminates while the OFF indica- y When a heavy article is placed on the
tor extinguishes), take the following seat.
If still the ON indicator remains illuminated actions.
while the OFF indicator extinguishes, take y Ensure that no article is placed on When the front passenger’s seat is occu-
the following actions. the seat other than the occupant. pied by an adult, observe the following
y Ensure that no article is placed on the y Ensure that there is no article left in precautions. Failure to do so may lessen
seat other than the child restraint system the seatback pocket. the load on the front passenger’s seat, de-
and the child occupant. activating the front passenger’s SRS fron-
y Ensure that there is no article left in the If the ON indicator still illuminates tal airbag despite the fact that the seat is
seatback pocket. while the OFF indicator extinguishes occupied by an adult.
y Ensure that the backward-forward posi- despite the fact that the actions noted y Do not allow the rear seat occupant to
tion and seatback of front passenger’s above have been taken, seat the child/ lift the front passenger’s seat cushion us-
seat are locked into place securely by small adult in the rear seat and immedi- ing his/her feet.
moving the seat back and forth. (Models ately contact your SUBARU dealer for y Do not place any article under the front
equipped with manual seats only) an inspection. Even if the system has passenger’s seat, or squeeze any article
passed the dealer inspection, it is rec- from behind and under the seat. This may
If the ON indicator still illuminates while ommended that on subsequent trips lift the seat cushion.
the OFF indicator extinguishes after tak- the child/small adult always take the y Do not squeeze any article between the
ing relevant corrective actions described rear seat. front passenger’s seat and side trim/pillar,
above, relocate the child restraint system door or center console box. This may lift
to the rear seat and immediately contact Children who have outgrown a child re- the seat cushion.
your SUBARU dealer for an inspection. straint system should always wear the
seatbelt irrespective of whether the airbag V If the passenger’s frontal airbag
NOTE is deactivated or activated. OFF indicator illuminates and the
When a child who has outgrown a child ON indicator extinguishes even
restraint system or a small adult is T Conditions in which front passen- when the front passenger’s seat is
seated in the front passenger’s seat, ger’s SRS frontal airbag is activated occupied by an adult
the Subaru advanced frontal airbag The front passenger’s SRS frontal airbag
system may or may not activate the This can be caused by the adult incorrect-
will be activated for deployment upon im- ly sitting in the front passenger’s seat.
front passenger’s SRS frontal airbag pact when any of the following conditions Turn the ignition switch to the “OFF” posi-
depending on the occupant’s seating is met regarding the front passenger’s
posture. If the front passenger’s SRS tion. Ask the front passenger to set the
seat. seatback to the upright position, sit up
frontal airbag is activated (the ON indi- y When the seat is occupied by an adult. straight in the center of the seat cushion,
Seat, seatbelt and SRS airbags 1-49
correctly fasten the seatbelt, position his/ T Effect vehicle modifications made <Puerto Rico>
her legs out forward, and adjust the seat for persons with disabilities may Trebol Subaru of Puerto Rico, Inc.
to the rearmost position. Turn the ignition have on Subaru advanced frontal P.O. Box 11204, San Juan, Puerto Rico
switch to the “ON” position. If the OFF in- airbag system operation (U.S. only) 00910
dicator remains illuminated while the ON Changing or moving any parts of the front 787-793-2828
indicator remains extinguished, take the seats, seat belts, front bumper, front side
following actions. There are currently no Subaru distributors
frame, instrument panel, combination in any other U.S. territories. If you are in
y Turn the ignition switch to the “OFF” po- meter, steering wheel, steering column,
sition. such an area, please contact the Subaru
tire, suspension or floor panel can affect distributor or dealer from which you
y Ensure that there is no article, book, the operation of the Subaru advanced air-
shoe, or other object trapped under the bought your vehicle.
bag system. If you have any questions,
seat, at the rear of the seat, or on the side you may contact the following Subaru dis-
of the seat. tributors:
y Ensure that the backward-forward posi-
tion and seatback of front passenger’s <Continental U.S., Alaska and the District
seat are locked into place securely by of Columbia>
moving the seat back and forth. (Models Subaru of America, Inc.
equipped with manual seats only) Customer Dealer Services Department
y Next, turn the ignition switch to the “ON” P.O. Box 6000
position and wait 6 seconds to allow the Cherry Hill, NJ 08034-6000
system to complete self-checking. Follow- 1-800-SUBARU3 (1-800-782-2783)
ing the system check, both indicators ex- <Hawaii>
tinguish for 2 seconds. Now, the ON indi- Schuman Carriage Motors, Inc.
cator should illuminate while the OFF indi- 1234 South Beretania Street, Honolulu, HI
cator remains extinguished. 96814
If the OFF indicator still illuminates while 808-592-4497
the ON indicator remains extinguished, <Guam>
ask the occupant to move to the rear seat Triple J Enterprises, Inc.
and immediately contact your SUBARU P.O. Box 6066, Tamuning, Guam 96931
dealer for an inspection. 671-646-9126
– CONTINUED –
1-50 Seat, seatbelt and SRS airbags
T Operation tem is designed to determine the activa- driver’s vision is not obstructed. The time
tion or deactivation condition of the front required from detecting impact to the de-
passenger’s SRS frontal airbag depend- flation of the SRS airbag after deployment
ing on the total load on the front passen- is shorter than the blink of an eye.
1
ger’s seat monitored by the front passen-
ger’s occupant detection system weight Both when only the driver’s SRS frontal
sensor. For this reason, only the driver’s airbag deploys and the driver’s and front
SRS frontal airbag may deploy in the passenger’s SRS frontal airbags deploy,
event of a collision, but this does not mean the driver’s and front passenger’s seatbelt
failure of the system. pretensioners operate at the same time.
If the front sub sensors inside both front Although it is highly unlikely that the SRS
fenders and the impact sensors in the air- airbag would activate in a non-accident
bag control module detect a predeter- situation, should it occur, the SRS airbag
mined amount of force during a frontal col- will deflate quickly, not obscuring vision
lision, the control module sends signals to and will not interfere with the driver’s abil-
the airbag module(s) (only driver’s module ity to maintain control of the vehicle.
2
or both driver’s and front passenger’s When the SRS airbag deploys, a sudden,
modules) instructing the module(s) to in- fairly loud inflation noise will be heard and
flate the SRS frontal airbag(s). The driv- some smoke will be released. These oc-
er’s and front passenger’s SRS frontal air- currences are a normal result of the de-
bags use dual stage inflators. The two in- ployment. This smoke does not indicate a
flators of each airbag are triggered either fire in the vehicle.
sequentially or simultaneously, depending
on the severity of impact, backward-for-
ward adjustment of the driver’s seat posi-
100534
tion and fastening/unfastening of the seat-
1) Driver’s side belt in the case of the driver’s SRS frontal
2) Passenger’s side airbag and depending on the severity of
impact and the total load on the seat in the
The SRS airbag can function only when case of the front passenger’s SRS frontal
the ignition switch is in the “ON” position. airbag. After deployment, the SRS airbag
The Subaru advanced frontal airbag sys- immediately starts to deflate so that the
Seat, seatbelt and SRS airbags 1-51
the visible damage done to the vehicle it- V Examples of the types of accidents
self. in which it is possible that the driv-
Do not touch the SRS airbag system er’s/driver’s and front passenger’s
V Examples of accident in which the SRS frontal airbag(s) will deploy.
components around the steering driver’s/driver’s and front passen-
wheel and dashboard with bare ger’s SRS frontal airbag(s) will most
hands right after deployment. Doing likely deploy.
so can cause burns because the
components can be very hot as a re-
sult of deployment.
The driver’s SRS frontal airbag and front
passenger’s SRS frontal airbag are de-
signed to deploy in the event of an acci-
dent involving a moderate to severe fron-
tal collision. It is basically not designed to
deploy in lesser frontal impacts because
the necessary protection can be achieved
by the seatbelt alone. Also, they are basi-
cally not designed to deploy in side or rear 200312
impacts or in roll-over accidents because
deployment of only the driver’s SRS fron- A head-on collision against a thick con-
tal airbag or both driver’s and front pas- crete wall at a vehicle speed of 12 to 19
senger’s SRS frontal airbags would not mph (20 to 30 km/h) or higher activates
help the occupant in those situations. The only the driver’s SRS frontal airbag or both
driver’s and front passenger’s SRS frontal driver’s and front passenger’s SRS frontal
airbags are designed to function on a one- airbags. The airbag(s) will also be activat-
time-only basis. ed when the vehicle is exposed to a frontal
impact similar in fashion and magnitude to
SRS airbag deployment depends on the
the collision described above. 100277
level of force experienced in the passen-
ger compartment during a collision. That The only the driver’s SRS frontal airbag or
level differs from one type of collision to both driver’s and front passenger’s SRS
another, and it may have no bearing on
– CONTINUED –
1-52 Seat, seatbelt and SRS airbags
frontal airbags may be activated when the V Examples of the types of accidents might not necessarily require deployment
vehicle sustains a hard impact in the un- in which deployment of the driver’s/ of driver’s/driver’s and front passenger’s
dercarriage area from the road surface driver’s and front passenger’s SRS SRS frontal airbag(s). If the vehicle strikes
(such as when the vehicle plunges into a frontal airbag(s) is unlikely to de- an object, such as a telephone pole or
deep ditch, is severely impacted or ploy. sign pole, or if it slides under a truck’s load
knocked hard against an obstacle on the bed, or if it sustains an oblique offset fron-
road such as a curb). tal impact, the driver’s/driver’s and front
passenger’s SRS frontal airbag(s) may
not deploy depending on the level of acci-
dent forces involved.
100278
V Examples of the types of accidents to deploy if the vehicle is struck from the SRS side airbag and SRS cur-
in which the driver’s/driver’s and side or from behind, or if it rolls onto its tain airbag
front passenger’s SRS frontal air- side or roof, or if it is involved in a low-
bag(s) will basically not deploy. speed frontal collision. The SRS side airbag is stored in the door
side of each front seat seatback, which
bears an “SRS AIRBAG” label.
2 In a moderate to severe side impact colli-
sion, the SRS side airbag on the impacted
side of the vehicle deploys between the
occupant and the door panel and supple-
ments the seatbelt by reducing the impact
on the occupant’s chest and waist. The
SRS side airbag operates only for front
1 seat occupants.
The SRS curtain airbag on each side of
the cabin is stored in the roof side (be-
100539 tween the front pillar and a point over the
rear seat). An “SRS AIRBAG” mark is lo-
1) First impact cated at the top of each center pillar.
2) Second impact
In a moderate to severe side impact colli-
In an accident where the vehicle is impact- sion, the SRS curtain airbag on the im-
ed more than once, the driver’s and/or pacted side of the vehicle deploys be-
front passenger’s SRS frontal airbag(s) tween the occupant and the side window
will deploy only once on the first impact. and supplements the seatbelt by reducing
the impact on the occupant’s head.
Example: In the case of a double collision,
first with another vehicle, then against a
concrete wall in immediate succession,
once either or both of the driver’s and front
100279 passenger’s SRS frontal airbags is/are ac-
tivated on the first impact, it/they will not
The driver’s and front passenger’s SRS be activated on the second impact.
frontal airbags are designed basically not
– CONTINUED –
1-54 Seat, seatbelt and SRS airbags
The SRS side airbag and SRS cur- y Do not sit or lean unnecessarily
tain airbag are designed as only a close to either front door. The
supplement to the primary protec- SRS side airbag is stored in both
tion provided by the seatbelt. They front seat seatbacks next to the
do not do away with the need to fas- door, and it provides protection
ten seatbelts. It is also important to by deploying rapidly (faster than
wear your seatbelt to help avoid in- the blink of an eye) in the event of
juries that can result when an occu- a side impact collision. However,
pant is not seated in a proper up- the force of SRS side airbag de-
right position. ployment may cause injuries if 100165
your head or other parts of the
body are too close to the SRS side
airbag.
y Since your vehicle is equipped Do not rest your arm on either front
with SRS curtain airbags, do not door or its internal trim. It could be
sit or lean unnecessarily close to injured in the event of SRS side air-
the front or rear door on either bag deployment.
side. The SRS curtain airbag on
each side of the cabin is stored in
the roof side (between the front
pillar and a point over the rear
seat), and it provides protection
100164 by deploying rapidly (faster than
the blink of an eye) in the event of
a side impact. However, the force
of its deployment may cause inju-
ries if your head is too close to it.
Seat, seatbelt and SRS airbags 1-55
– CONTINUED –
1-56 Seat, seatbelt and SRS airbags
senses an impact force above a predeter- deployment depend on the level of force
mined level in a side collision, the control experienced in the passenger compart-
module causes both the SRS side airbag Do not touch the SRS side airbag ment during a side impact collision. That
and curtain airbag on the impacted side to system components around the level differs from one type of collision to
inflate regardless of whether the rear front seat seatback with bare hands another, and it may have no bearing on
wheel house impact sensor on the same right after deployment. Doing so can the visible damage done to the vehicle it-
side senses an impact. If it is a rear wheel cause burns because the compo- self.
house impact sensor alone that senses a nents can be very hot as a result of
sufficiently strong impact force, the control V Example of the type of accident in
deployment. which the SRS side airbag and SRS
module causes only the SRS curtain air-
bag on the impacted side to inflate. After After deployment, do not touch any curtain airbag will most likely de-
the deployment, the SRS side airbag im- part of the SRS curtain airbag sys- ploy.
mediately starts to deflate. The time re- tem (from the front pillar to the part
quired from detection of an impact to de- of the roof side over the rear seat).
flation of an SRS side airbag after deploy- Doing so can cause burns because
ment is shorter than the blink of an eye. the components can be very hot as
The SRS curtain airbag remains inflated a result of deployment.
for a while following deployment then The SRS side airbag and SRS curtain air-
slowly deflates. bag are designed to deploy in the event of
The SRS side airbag and SRS curtain air- an accident involving a moderate to se-
bag deploy even when no one occupies vere side impact collision. It is basically
the seat on the side on which an impact is not designed to deploy in a lesser side im-
applied. pact. Also, it is basically not designed to
deploy in frontal or rear impacts because 200320
When the SRS side airbag and SRS cur- SRS side airbag and SRS curtain airbag
tain airbag deploy, a sudden, fairly loud in- deployment would not help the occupant A severe side impact near the front seat
flation noise will be heard and some in those situations. activates the SRS side airbag and SRS
smoke will be released. These occurrenc- Each SRS side airbag and SRS curtain curtain airbag.
es are a normal result of the deployment. airbag are designed to function on a one-
This smoke does not indicate a fire in the time-only basis.
vehicle.
SRS side airbag and SRS curtain airbag
– CONTINUED –
1-58 Seat, seatbelt and SRS airbags
V Examples of the types of accidents in which the SRS side airbag and SRS cur- 1) The vehicle is involved in an oblique
tain airbag are unlikely to deploy. side-on impact.
2) The vehicle is involved in a side-on
impact in an area outside the vicinity
1 2 of the passenger compartment.
3) The vehicle strikes a telephone pole
or similar object.
4) The vehicle is involved in a side-on
impact from a motorcycle.
5) The vehicle rolls onto its side or roof.
100658
Seat, seatbelt and SRS airbags 1-59
V Examples of the types of accidents ary). immediately followed by another from the
in which the SRS side airbag and 2) The vehicle is struck from behind. same direction, once the SRS side airbag
SRS curtain airbag will basically not and SRS curtain airbag are activated on
The SRS side airbag and SRS curtain air-
deploy. the first impact, they will not be activated
bag are basically not designed to deploy if
on the second.
the vehicle is involved in a frontal collision
or is struck from behind. Examples of such
accidents are illustrated. SRS airbag system monitors
B
2
A
1
2
100660 200326
1) The vehicle is involved in frontal collision Example: In the case of a double side im- The following components are monitored
with another vehicle (moving or station- pact collision, first with one vehicle and by the indicator:
y Front sub sensor (Right-hand side)
– CONTINUED –
1-60 Seat, seatbelt and SRS airbags
y Front sub sensor (Left-hand side) y Front passenger’s frontal airbag ON SRS airbag system servicing
y Airbag control module (including impact and OFF indicator
sensors) y All related wiring
y Frontal airbag module (Driver’s side)
y Frontal airbag module (Front passen- y When discarding an airbag mod-
ger’s side) ule or scrapping the entire vehicle
y Side airbag sensor (Center pillar right- If the warning light exhibits any of damaged by a collision, consult
hand side) the following conditions, there may your SUBARU dealer.
y Side airbag sensor (Center pillar left- be a malfunction in the seatbelt pre-
tensioners and/or SRS airbag sys- y The SRS airbag has no user-ser-
hand side)
viceable parts. Do not use electri-
y Side airbag module (Driver’s side) tem. Immediately take your vehicle
cal test equipment on any circuit
y Side airbag module (Front passenger’s to your nearest SUBARU dealer to
have the system checked. Unless related to the SRS airbag system.
side)
For required servicing of the SRS
y Curtain airbag sensor (Rear wheel checked and properly repaired, the
seatbelt pretensioners and/or SRS airbag, see your nearest SUBARU
house right-hand side)
dealer. Tampering with or discon-
y Curtain airbag sensor (Rear wheel airbags will operate improperly (e.g.
SRS airbags may inflate in a very mi- necting the system’s wiring could
house left-hand side)
result in accidental inflation of the
y Curtain airbag module (Right side) nor collision or not inflate in a se-
SRS airbag or could make the sys-
y Curtain airbag module (Left side) vere collision), which may increase
tem inoperative, which may result
y Seatbelt pretensioner (Driver’s side) the risk of injury.
in serious injury. The wiring har-
y Seatbelt pretensioner (Front passen- y Flashing or flickering of the warn- nesses of the SRS airbag system
ger’s side) ing light are covered with yellow insulation
y Seatbelt buckle switch (Driver’s side)
y No illumination of the warning and system connectors are yellow
y Seatbelt buckle switch (Front passen-
light when the ignition switch is for easy identification.
ger’s side)
y Driver’s seat position sensor first turned to the “ON” position
y Front passenger’s seatbelt tension sen- y Continuous illumination of the
sor warning light
y Front passenger’s occupant detection y Illumination of the warning light
system weight sensor while driving
y Front passenger’s occupant detection
control module
Seat, seatbelt and SRS airbags 1-61
– CONTINUED –
1-62 Seat, seatbelt and SRS airbags
Keys and door locks. You can keep the trunk number plate attached to the key set.
Keys and doors
and glove box locked when you leave your Write down the key number and keep it in
vehicle and valet key at a parking facility. another safe place, not in the vehicle. This
number is needed to make a replacement
1 2 3 5 key if you lose your key or lock it inside the
vehicle.
Do not attach a large key holder or
4 key case to either key. If it bangs For information on making replacement
against your knees while you are keys for vehicles with the immobilizer sys-
driving, it could turn the ignition tem, refer to the “Immobilizer” section in
switch from the ON position to the this chapter.
ACC or OFF position, thereby stop-
ping the engine.
200700
Key number
1) Master key
2) Submaster key
3) Valet key
4) Key number plate
5) Security ID plate
Key replacement
Your key number plate and security ID
plate will be required if you ever need a re-
placement key made. Any new key must
be registered for use with your vehicle’s
200835 immobilizer system before it can be used.
Up to four keys can be registered for use
The security indicator light deters potential with one vehicle.
thieves by indicating that the vehicle is For security, all the keys registered with
equipped with an immobilizer system. It 200836
your vehicle’s immobilizer system will
begins flashing approximately 60 seconds have their ID codes erased and re-regis- To lock the driver’s door from the outside
after the ignition switch is turned from the tered when a new key is made. Therefore, with the key, turn the key toward the rear.
“ON” position to the “ACC” or “LOCK” po- all of your vehicle’s keys must be present- To unlock the door, turn the key toward
sition or immediately after the key is pulled ed when a new key is registered. Any key the front.
out. that is not re-registered when a new key is
If the security indicator light does not made cannot be used after the other keys Lift the outside door handle to open an un-
flash, the immobilizer system may be are re-registered. For information on re- locked door.
faulty. If this occurs, contact your placement keys and on the registration of
SUBARU dealer as soon as possible. keys with your immobilizer system, con-
tact your SUBARU dealer.
In case an unauthorized key is used (e.g.
an imitation key), the security indicator
light comes on.
Keys and doors 2-5
LO
C
K
Keep all doors locked when you
drive, especially when small chil-
2 2 dren are in your vehicle.
Along with the proper use of seat-
belts and child restraints, locking
the doors reduces the chance of be-
200837 200838
ing thrown out of the vehicle in an
accident.
Locking without the key Locking without the key It also helps prevent passengers
1) Rotate the lock lever rearward. 1) Push the power door locking switch for- from falling out if a door is acciden-
2) Close the door. ward. tally opened, and intruders from un-
2) Close the door. expectedly opening doors and en-
To lock the door from the outside without
the key, rotate the lock lever rearward and To lock the door from the outside using the tering your vehicle.
then close the door. power door locking switch, push the
switch forward (“LOCK” side) and then
close the door. In this case, all closed
doors and the rear gate (Station wagon)
are locked at the same time.
Always make sure that all doors and the
rear gate are locked before leaving your
vehicle.
NOTE
Make sure that you do not leave the key
inside the vehicle before locking the
doors from the outside without the key. 200384
– CONTINUED –
2-6 Keys and doors
To lock the door from the inside, rotate the open warning light remain illuminated as a Power door locking switches
lock lever rearward. result, the lights are automatically turned
off by the battery drainage prevention
function after 10 minutes of illumination to
prevent the battery from going dead. The
operational/non-operational setting of this
function can be changed by a SUBARU
dealer. Contact the nearest SUBARU
dealer if you would like to change the set-
ting.
NOTE
y When leaving the vehicle, please
LO
make sure that all doors and the rear
C
K
200385 gate (Station wagon) are completely 200386
closed.
To unlock the door from the inside, rotate y The battery drainage prevention Driver’s switch
the lock lever forward. function does not operate while the key
The red mark on the lock lever appears is in the ignition switch.
when the door is unlocked.
Pull the inside door handle to open an un-
locked door.
Always make sure that all doors and the
rear gate (Station wagon) are closed and
locked before starting to drive.
All doors and the rear gate (Station wag- (“LOCK”) position. Remote keyless entry sys-
on) can be locked and unlocked by the
power door locking switches located at the T Behavior with key lock-in preven- tem
driver’s side and the front passenger’s tion function non-operative
side doors. y If the lock lever is turned to the rear
(“LOCK”) position with the driver’s door
To lock all doors (including the rear gate of open and the driver’s door is then closed y Do not expose the transmitter to
a Station wagon), push the switch to the with the lock lever in that position, the driv- severe shocks, such as those ex-
front (“LOCK”) position. er’s door is locked. perienced as a result of dropping
To unlock all doors (including the rear y If the spare key is used to lock the driv- or throwing.
gate of a Station wagon), pull the switch to er’s door from the outside of the vehicle,
the rear position. y Do not take the transmitter apart
the door is locked. except when replacing the bat-
When you close the doors after you set This function’s operative/non-operative tery.
the door locks, the doors remain locked. setting can be changed by a SUBARU y Do not get the transmitter wet. If it
NOTE dealer. Contact a SUBARU dealer for de- gets wet, wipe it dry with a cloth
tails. immediately.
Make sure that you do not leave the key
inside the vehicle before locking the NOTE This device complies with Part 15 of
doors from the outside using the pow- When leaving the vehicle, make sure the FCC Rules and with RSS-210 of In-
er door locking switches. you are holding the key before locking dustry Canada. Operation is subject to
the doors. the following two conditions: (1) This
Key lock-in prevention func- device may not cause harmful interfer-
tion ence, and (2) this device must accept
any interference received, including in-
This function prevents the doors from be-
terference that may cause undesired
ing locked with the key still in the ignition
operation.
switch.
Changes or modifications not express-
T Behavior with key lock-in preven- ly approved by the party responsible
tion function operative for compliance could void the user’s
With the driver’s door open, the doors are authority to operate the equipment.
automatically kept unlocked even if the Two transmitters are provided for your ve-
door locking switch is pushed to the front
– CONTINUED –
2-8 Keys and doors
Unlocking the doors Unlocking the trunk lid/rear light stays illuminated for approximately
gate 30 seconds if any of the doors or the rear
gate (Station wagon) is not opened.
If the “ ” button is pressed before 30
seconds have elapsed, this light will go
out. The interior light must be set to the
middle position in order for this function
to operate.
A SUBARU dealer can change the illumi-
nation period setting of the interior light in
accordance with your preference. Contact
the nearest SUBARU dealer for details.
200900
Vehicle finder function
200901
Press the “ ” button to unlock the driv- Use this function to find your vehicle
er’s door. An electronic chirp will sound T Sedan parked among many vehicles in a large
twice and the turn signal lights will flash parking lot. Provided you are within 30
The trunk lid unlocks when the “ ”
twice. To unlock all doors and the rear feet (10 meters) of the vehicle, pressing
button is pressed continuously for at least
gate (Station wagon), briefly press the the “ ” button three times in a five-sec-
2 seconds. An electronic chirp will sound
“ ” button a second time within 5 sec- ond period will cause your vehicle’s horn
twice and the turn signal lights will flash
onds. to sound once and its turn signal lights to
twice.
flash three times.
NOTE T Station wagon
If the interval between the first and sec- NOTE
Pressing the “ ” button opens the If the interval between presses is too
ond presses of the “ ” button (for
unlocking of all of the doors and the rear gate. short when you press the “ ” button
rear gate) is extremely short, the sys- An electronic chirp will sound twice and three times, the system may not re-
the turn signal lights will flash twice. spond to the signals from the remote
tem may not respond.
transmitter.
Illuminated entry
The interior (dome) light will illuminate
when the “ ” button is pressed. This
– CONTINUED –
2-10 Keys and doors
Sounding a panic alarm the audible signal off. To replace the battery:
Do the following to deactivate the audible
signal. You can also use the same steps
to restore the function.
1. Sit in the driver’s seat and shut all
doors and the rear gate.
2. Hold down the UNLOCK side of the
power door locking switch.
3. While holding down the “UNLOCK”
side of the power door locking switch, pull
the key out and re-insert it into the ignition
switch at least 6 times within 10 seconds
after Step 2.
200902
200714 4. Open and close the driver’s door once
within 10 seconds after Step 3. 1. Open the transmitter case using a flat-
A “PANIC” button is located on the back of 5. The turn signal lights flash 3 times to in-
the transmitter. head screwdriver.
dicate completion of the setting.
To activate the alarm, press the “PANIC”
button once. You may have the above settings done by
The horn will sound and the turn signal your SUBARU dealer.
lights will flash.
To deactivate the panic alarm, press any Replacing the battery
button on the remote transmitter. Unless a
button on the remote is pressed, the alarm
will be deactivated after approximately 30
seconds. Do not let dust, oil or water get on or
in the transmitter when replacing
Selecting audible signal op- the battery.
eration When the transmitter battery begins to get
200716
Using an electronic chirp, the system will weak, transmitter range will begin to de- 2. Remove the old battery from the hold-
give you an audible signal when the doors crease. Replace the battery as soon as er.
lock and unlock. If desired, you may turn possible.
Keys and doors 2-11
1) Negative (–) side facing up Programming transmitter codes into Transmitter circuit board
system:
3. Replace with a new battery (Type To register a new transmitter with the key-
CR2025 or equivalent) making sure to in- less entry system, it is necessary to pro-
stall the new battery with the negative (–) gram the transmitter’s code (identification
side facing up. number) into the system. A label showing
4. Refit the removed half of the transmit- the code is affixed to the bag containing
ter case. the transmitter, and another is affixed to
the circuit board inside the transmitter. If
After the battery is replaced, the trans- there is no bag, open the transmitter case
mitter must be synchronized with the and make a note of the eight-digit number.
keyless entry system’s control unit. Program the number into the system in
Press either the “ ” or “ ” button accordance with the following procedure:
six times to synchronize the unit. 1. Firmly close the doors and the rear
200718 gate (Station wagon) or trunk lid (Sedan).
Replacing lost transmitters 2. Open the driver’s door, sit on the driv-
Bag containing transmitter er’s seat, and close the door.
If you lose a transmitter or want to pur-
chase additional transmitters (up to four 3. Perform the following steps within 45
can be programmed), you should re-pro- seconds.
– CONTINUED –
2-12 Keys and doors
LO
C
dure again beginning with part 1.
K
200840 200841
4. Open and close the door once within
1) Open and close the driver’s door 15 seconds. 5. Before the electronic tone stops sound-
once. ing, press the power door lock knob to the
NOTE “LOCK” side the same number of times as
y When part 4 of the procedure is com- the leftmost digit of the transmitter code.
pleted, an electronic tone will sound For example, press the lock knob eight
for 30 seconds. times if the leftmost digit of the code is 8.
y If you do not perform the operations
2 in part 4 within 15 seconds, an error NOTE
1
will occur and the electronic tone will y The electronic tone will stop sound-
not sound. In this event, perform the ing when you start entering the num-
registration steps again beginning with ber.
part 3 of the procedure. y If you do not start entering the num-
ber using the lock knob before the
electronic tone stops sounding, an er-
200721 ror will occur. In this event, perform the
registration steps again beginning with
1) LOCK
part 3 of the procedure.
2) ON
y If the interval between one push of
2) Insert the key into the ignition switch, the knob and the next exceeds five sec-
Keys and doors 2-13
onds, an error will occur. In this event, 7. Perform parts 5 and 6 of the procedure tered the second time is identical to that
perform the procedure again beginning for each of the remaining digits of the entered the first time.
with part 4. If an error occurs six times, transmitter code beginning with the sec-
perform the procedure again starting ond digit (counting from the left) and fin- NOTE
with part 3. ishing with the eighth digit. If the code entered the second time is
not identical to the code entered the
NOTE first time, an error will occur. In this
y When you finish entering the eighth event, perform the procedure again be-
digit, an electronic tone will sound for ginning with part 5. If an error occurs
30 seconds. five times, perform the procedure
y If the interval between one push of again starting with part 3.
the knob and the next exceeds five sec-
onds, an error will occur. In this event, 10.If you wish to program another trans-
perform the procedure again beginning mitter code into the system (up to four
with part 4. If an error occurs six times, transmitter codes can be programmed
perform the procedure again starting into the system), perform the procedure
beginning with part 4. When you have fin-
LO
with part 3.
C
200842 8. Before the electronic tone stops sound- transmitter codes into the system, remove
ing, use the power door lock knob to again the key from the ignition switch.
6. When you have finished entering the enter the transmitter code beginning with 11.Test every registered transmitter to
number, pull the lock knob to the “UN- the leftmost digit. confirm correct operation.
LOCK” side within five seconds.
NOTE T Deleting old transmitter codes
NOTE If you do not start entering the number The control unit of the keyless entry sys-
y An electronic tone will sound. using the lock knob before the elec- tem has four memory locations to store
y If you pull the lock knob to the “UN- tronic tone stops sounding, an error transmitter codes, giving it the ability to
LOCK” side when more than five sec- will occur. In this event, perform the operate with up to four transmitters. When
onds have passed, an error will occur. procedure again beginning with part 3. you lose a transmitter, the lost transmit-
In this event, perform the procedure
ter’s code remains in the memory. For se-
again beginning with part 4. If an error 9. When you have finished entering the
curity reasons, lost transmitter codes
occurs six times, perform the proce- code a second time, an electronic tone will
sound for one second to indicate comple- should be deleted from the memory.
dure again starting with part 3.
To delete old transmitter codes, program
tion of registration, provided the code en-
– CONTINUED –
2-14 Keys and doors
four transmitter codes into the system. If Alarm system y Opening a door, the rear gate or trunk
you have only one current transmitter, lid
program it four times. If you have two cur- The alarm system helps to protect your y Physical impact to the vehicle, such as
rent transmitters, program each one twice. vehicle and valuables from theft. The horn forced entry (only vehicles with shock sen-
If you have three current transmitters, pro- sounds and the turn signal lights flash if sors (dealer option))
gram two of them once and the third one someone attempts to break into your vehi-
twice. This process will leave only current cle. Activating and deactivating
transmitter codes in the system’s memory.
The system can be armed and disarmed the alarm system
NOTE with the remote transmitter. To change the setting of your vehicle’s
Make sure no one else is operating The system does not operate when the alarm system for activation or deactiva-
their keyless entry system within range key is inserted into the ignition switch. tion, do the following.
of your vehicle when programming 1. Disarm the alarm system (see “Disarm-
transmitters. If someone else were to Your vehicle’s alarm system has been set ing the system” in this section).
operate their remote transmitter while for activation at the time of shipment from 2. Sit in the driver’s seat and shut all
you are programming your transmit- the factory. You can set the system for de- doors (and the rear gate if your vehicle is
ters, it is possible that their transmitter activation yourself or have it done by your a Station wagon).
code will be programmed into your SUBARU dealer. 3. Turn the ignition switch to the “ON” po-
system, allowing them unauthorized sition.
access to your vehicle. System alarm operation 4. Hold down the UNLOCK side of the
The alarm system will give the following driver’s power door locking switch, open
alarms when triggered: the driver’s door within the following 1 sec-
y The vehicle’s horn will sound and the ond, and wait 10 seconds without releas-
turn signal lights will flash for 30 seconds. ing the switch. The setting will then be
y If any door (or the rear gate/trunk lid) re- changed as follows:
mains open after the 30-second period, If the system was previously activated:
the horn will continue to sound for a maxi- The odometer/trip meter screen displays
mum of 3 minutes. If the door (or the rear “AL oF” and the horn sounds twice, indi-
gate/trunk lid) is closed while the horn is cating that the system is now deactivated.
sounding, the horn will stop sounding with
a delay of up to 30 seconds. If the system was previously deactivated:
The odometer/trip meter screen displays
The alarm is triggered by:
Keys and doors 2-15
“AL on” and the horn sounds once, indi- 5. Close all doors (and the rear gate on than two seconds). All doors (and the rear
cating that the system is now activated. the Station wagon). gate on the Station wagon) will lock, an
electronic chirp will sound once, the turn
NOTE signal lights will flash once, and the indica-
You may have the above setting tor lights will start flashing rapidly. After
change done by your SUBARU dealer. rapid flashing for 30 seconds (standby
time), the indicator lights will then flash
If you have accidentally trig- slowly (twice approximately every two
gered the alarm system seconds), indicating that the system has
been armed for surveillance.
T To stop the alarm
If any of the doors, (rear gate or trunk lid)
Do any of the following operations: is not fully closed, an electronic chirp
y Insert the key in the door lock of the sounds five times, the turn signal lights
driver’s door and turn it to the unlock posi- 200918 flash five times to alert you that the doors
tion. (or the rear gate) are not properly closed.
y Press any button on the remote trans- : Press to Arm the system. When you close the door, the system will
mitter. : Press to Disarm the system.
automatically arm and doors will automat-
y Turn the ignition switch to the “ON” po- ically lock.
sition.
T To arm the system using power
Arming the system door locking switches
1. Close all windows.
T To arm the system using remote 2. Remove the key from the ignition
transmitter switch.
1. Close all windows and the moonroof (if 3. Open the doors and get out of the vehi-
so equipped). cle.
2. Remove the key from the ignition 4. Make sure that the engine hood is
switch. locked.
3. Open the doors and get out of the vehi- 5. Close the doors (and the rear gate on
cle. 200835 the station wagon) but leave only the driv-
4. Make sure that the engine hood (and er’s door or the front passenger’s door
the trunk lid on the Sedan) are locked. 6. Briefly press the “ ” button (for less open.
– CONTINUED –
2-16 Keys and doors
LO
mitter’s “ ” button with the alarm NOTE
C
K
system armed, the system will be tem- If the interval between the first and sec-
porarily placed in a standby state. The ond presses of the “ ” button (for
system will go back to the surveillance unlocking of all of the doors and the
state upon locking the trunk. rear gate) is extremely short, the sys-
y The system is in the standby mode tem may not respond.
for a 30-second period after locking the Or the system can be disarmed by the
200897
doors with the remote transmitter. The following method, too.
6. Push the front side (“LOCK” side) of security indicator light will flash at y Insert the key in the door lock of the
the power door locking switch to set the short intervals during this period. driver’s door and turn it to the unlock
door locks. y If any of the following actions is done position.
7. Close the door. An electronic chirp will during the standby period, the system
will not switch to the surveillance state. T Emergency disarming
sound once, the turn signal lights will flash
once and the indicator lights will start y Doors are unlocked using the re- If you cannot disarm the system using the
flashing rapidly. After rapid flashing for 30 mote transmitter. transmitter (i.e. the transmitter is lost, bro-
seconds (standby time), the indicator y Any door (including the rear gate ken or the transmitter battery is too weak),
lights will then flash slowly (twice approxi- of a Station wagon or the trunk of a you can disarm the system without using
mately every two seconds), indicating that Sedan) is opened. the transmitter.
the system has been armed for surveil- y Ignition switch is turned to the The system can be disarmed if you turn
lance. “ON” position. the ignition switch from the “LOCK” to the
“ON” position with a registered key.
NOTE Disarming the system Insert the key in the door lock of the driv-
y The system can be armed even if the er’s door and turn it to the unlock position.
Briefly press the “ ” button (for less
engine hood, the windows and/or
than two seconds) on the remote transmit-
moonroofs are opened. Always make ter. The driver’s door will unlock, an elec- Valet mode
sure that they are fully closed before
tronic chirp will sound twice, the turn sig- When you choose the valet mode, the
arming the system.
nal lights will flash twice and the indicator alarm system does not operate. In valet
Keys and doors 2-17
mode, the remote transmitter is used only T Arming the system “LOCK” position and remove the key from
for locking and unlocking the doors and the ignition switch.
rear gate (Station wagon) and panic acti- 3. Open the doors and get out of the vehi-
vation. cle.
In passive mode, the system will au-
To enter the valet mode, change the set- tomatically activate the alarm but
ting of your vehicle’s alarm system for de- WILL NOT automatically lock the
activation mode. (Refer to “Activating and doors. In order to lock the doors you
deactivating the alarm system” in this sec- must either lock them as indicated
tion.) The security indicator light will con- in step 4 below or with the key once
tinue to flash once every three seconds in- they have been closed. Failure to
dicating that the system is in the valet lock the doors manually will result
mode. in a higher security risk.
To exit valet mode, change the setting of 1. Turn the ignition switch to the “ON” po-
your vehicle’s alarm system for activation sition.
mode. (Refer to “Activating and deactivat- 200704
ing the alarm system” in this section.)
4. Before closing the doors, lock all doors
Passive arming with the inside door lock levers.
5. Close the doors. The system will auto-
When passive arming mode has been 2
1 matically arm after one minute.
programmed by the dealer, arming of the
system is automatically accomplished In the passive mode, the system can also
without using the remote transmitter. Note be armed with the remote transmitter or
that in this mode, DOORS MUST BE with the power door locking switches. If
MANUALLY LOCKED. the remote transmitter or power door lock-
ing switch is used to lock the vehicle, arm-
T To enter the passive mode
200721 ing will take place immediately regardless
If you wish to program the passive arming of whether or not the passive mode has
mode, have it done by your SUBARU 1) LOCK been selected.
dealer. 2) ON
T Disarming the system flash for a short time when the sensed im- Child safety locks
To disarm the system, briefly press the pact is weak, but it warns of a strong im-
“ ” button on the transmitter. pact or multiple impacts by sounding the
horn and flashing the turn signal lights,
both lasting approximately 30 seconds.
Tripped sensor identification If you desire, your SUBARU dealer can
Always use the child safety lock
The security indicator light flashes when whenever a child rides in the rear
connect them and set them for activation
the alarm system has been triggered. Al- seat. Serious injury could result if a
or deactivation.
so, the number of flashes indicates the lo- child accidentally opened the door
cation of unauthorized intrusion or the se- NOTE and fell out.
verity of impact on the vehicle. y The shock sensors are not always
y When the ignition switch is turned to the able to sense impacts caused by
“ON” position, the indicator light will light breaking in, and cannot sense an im-
for 1 second and then flash as follows: pact that does not cause vibration
When a door or rear gate (Station wag- (such as breaking the glass using a
on) was opened: 5 times rescue hammer).
When the trunk (Sedan) was opened: 4 y The shock sensors may sense vibra-
times tion like those shown in the following
When a strong impact or multiple im- and trigger the alarm system. Select
pacts were sensed: twice (only vehicles the settings of the alarm system and
with shock sensors (dealer option)) shock sensors appropriately depend-
When a light impact was sensed: once ing on where you usually park your ve-
(only vehicles with shock sensors (deal- hicle. 200247
er option)) Example:
Vibration from construction site Each rear door has a child safety lock that
Vibration in multistory car park prevents the doors from being opened
Shock sensors (dealer op- Vibration from trains even if the inside door handle is pulled.
tion) y You can have the sensitivity of the When the child safety lock lever is in the
The shock sensors trigger the alarm sys- shock sensors adjusted to your prefer- lock position, the door cannot be opened
tem when they sense impacts applied to ence by your SUBARU dealer. from inside regardless of the position of
the vehicle and when any of their electric
the inner door handle lock lever. The door
wires is cut. The alarm system causes the
can only be opened from the outside.
horn to sound and the turn signal lights to
Keys and doors 2-19
Power windows
1 1
2
2
To avoid serious personal injury
3
caused by entrapment, you must do
the following.
4
y When operating the power win-
dows, be extremely careful to pre- 5
vent anyone’s fingers, arms, neck
or head from being caught in the 200843 200844
window.
1) Lock switch 1) Open
y Always lock the passengers’ win- 2) For driver’s window 2) Automatically open
dows using the lock switch when 3) For front passenger’s window
children are riding in the vehicle. 4) For rear left passenger’s window To open:
y Before leaving the vehicle, always 5) For rear right passenger’s window Push the switch down lightly and hold it.
remove the key from the ignition The window will open as long as the
All door windows can be controlled by the switch is held.
switch for safety and never allow power window switch cluster at the driver
an unattended child to remain in This switch also has a one-touch auto
side door. down feature that allows the window to be
the vehicle. Failure to follow this
procedure could result in injury to opened fully without holding the switch.
a child operating the power win- Push the switch down until it clicks and re-
dow. lease it, and the window will fully open. To
stop the window halfway, pull the switch
The power windows operate only when up lightly.
the ignition switch is in the “ON” position.
– CONTINUED –
2-20 Keys and doors
200845
200398
To close:
Pull the switch up lightly and hold it. The To lock the passengers’ windows, push
window will close as long as the switch is 200847 the lock switch. When the lock switch is in
held. the “LOCK” position, the passengers’ win-
To close the window, pull the switch up dows cannot be opened or closed.
V Operating the passengers’ windows and hold it until it reaches the desired po- Press the switch again to cancel the pas-
sition. sengers’ window locking.
200846
Keys and doors 2-21
2
y To prevent dangerous exhaust
1 gas from entering the vehicle, al-
1
ways keep the trunk lid closed
while driving.
y Help prevent young children from
locking themselves in the trunk.
When leaving the vehicle, either
200849 close all windows and lock all
200848
Rear passengers’ window switches doors or cancel the inside trunk
1) Open lid release. Also make certain that
Front passenger’s window switch
2) Close the trunk is closed. On hot or sun-
1) Open
2) Close ny days, the temperature in the
To close the window, pull the switch up trunk could quickly become high
To open the window, push the switch and hold it until the window reaches the enough to cause death or serious
down and hold it until the window reaches desired position. heat-related injuries including
the desired position. When the lock switch on the power win- brain damage to anyone locked
dow switch cluster, located on the driver’s inside, particularly for small chil-
side door, is in the “LOCK” position, the dren.
passengers’ windows cannot be operated
with the passengers’ switches. To open and close the trunk
lid from outside
The trunk lid can be opened using the re-
mote keyless entry system. Refer to “Re-
mote keyless entry system” section in this
chapter.
To close the trunk lid, lightly press the
– CONTINUED –
2-22 Keys and doors
trunk lid down until the latch engages. To lock and unlock the trunk adults become locked inside the trunk, the
lid release lever handle allows them to open the lid. The
NOTE handle is located on the inside of the trunk
Do not leave your valuables in the lid.
trunk when you leave your vehicle.
200851
LOCK
200852
When you entrust your vehicle key to an-
other person, you can lock the trunk lid re- To open the trunk lid from inside the trunk,
lease lever to prevent luggage in the trunk press the yellow handle downward as indi-
from being stolen. To lock the trunk lid re- cated by the arrow on the handle. This op-
200850 lease lever, insert the master key or sub eration unlocks the trunk lid. Then, push
key into the key cylinder at the rear of the up the lid.
Pull the trunk lid release lever upward. release lever and turn it counterclockwise. The handle is made of material that re-
To unlock the trunk lid release lever, turn mains luminescent for approximately an
the key clockwise. hour in the dark trunk space after it is ex-
posed to ambient light even for a short
Internal trunk lid release han- time.
dle
The internal trunk lid release handle is a
device designed to open the trunk lid from
inside the trunk. In the event children or
Keys and doors 2-23
T Inspection
Perform the following steps at least twice
Never allow any child to get in the a year to check the release handle for cor-
trunk and play with the release han- rect operation.
dle. If the driver starts the vehicle 1. Open the trunk lid.
without knowing that a child is in-
side the trunk and the child opens
the lid using the release handle, the
child could fall out and be killed or
seriously injured.
200854
y Do not close the lid while gripping This places the latch in the locked posi-
the release handle. The handle tion.
may be damaged.
y Do not use the handle as a hook to 200853
fasten straps or ropes to secure
your cargo in the trunk. Such use 2. Use a screwdriver with a thin blade.
may result in damage of the han- Slide the screwdriver blade from the slit
dle. aperture of the lock assembly fully to the
end until you hear a click.
y Load the trunk so that cargo can
not strike the release handle. If the
cargo hits the handle while the ve-
hicle is being driven, the handle
may be pushed down and the
trunk lid may open. That may 200855
cause cargo to fall out of the
trunk, which could create a traffic 3. Move the release handle, from outside
safety hazard. the vehicle, in the direction of the arrow to
check if the latch is released.
If the latch is not released, contact your
– CONTINUED –
2-24 Keys and doors
200401
2 2
200858 200858
1) Open 1) Open
2) Close 2) Close
To tilt up the front moonroof, open the sun To fully open the rear moonroof, tilt up the
200404
shade and pull the switch to the “OPEN” front moonroof then pull the switch to the
The sun shade can be slid forward or side. “OPEN” side and quickly release it. The
backward by hand while the moonroof is To tilt down the front moonroof, push the rear moonroof will stop at a position ap-
closed. switch to the “CLOSE” side, then quickly proximately 6.7 in (17 cm) from its fully
If the moonroof is opened, the sun shade release it. If you wish to stop the tilting- closed position.
also moves back. down motion of the front moonroof part- After confirming safety, pull the switch to
way, either pull the switch to the “OPEN” the “OPEN” side again and quickly re-
side or push it to the “CLOSE” side. lease it. The rear moonroof will open to its
Moonroof (Station wagon) fully open position. To stop the rear moon-
The front moonroof has a tilting function roof at some selected mid-way point while
and the rear moonroof has a sliding func- it is moving toward its fully open position,
tion. momentarily push the switch to the
Both moonroofs operate only when the ig- “CLOSE” or “OPEN” side.
nition switch is in the “ON” position. To fully close the rear moonroof, push the
– CONTINUED –
2-28 Keys and doors
Cruise control set indicator light .......................... 3-25 Outside mirrors ....................................................... 3-41
Headlight indicator light ........................................ 3-25 Tilt steering wheel .............................................. 3-43
Front fog light indicator light ................................ 3-25
Horn ..................................................................... 3-43
Clock .................................................................... 3-25
Information display (Vehicle without
Navigation System) ......................................... 3-26
Outside temperature indicator .............................. 3-27
Current fuel consumption ...................................... 3-28
Average fuel consumption .................................... 3-28
Driving range on remaining fuel ........................... 3-29
Journey time ........................................................... 3-30
Light control switch ........................................... 3-31
Headlights ............................................................... 3-31
High/low beam change (dimmer) .......................... 3-31
Headlight flasher .................................................... 3-32
Daytime running light system ............................... 3-32
Turn signal lever ................................................. 3-32
Illumination brightness control ......................... 3-33
Parking light switch ........................................... 3-33
Front fog light switch (if equipped) .................. 3-34
Wiper and washer ............................................... 3-34
Windshield wiper and washer switches ............... 3-35
Rear window wiper and washer switch (Station
wagon) .................................................................. 3-37
Windshield wiper deicer (if equipped) .............. 3-38
Rear window defogger button ........................... 3-38
Mirrors ................................................................. 3-40
Inside mirror ........................................................... 3-40
Auto-dimming mirror/compass (if equipped) ...... 3-40
Instruments and controls 3-3
ON
This is the normal operating position after
the engine is started. 300503
Key reminder chime Hazard warning flasher Meters and gauges (Turbo
The reminder chime sounds when the models)
driver’s door opens and the key is in the
“LOCK” or “ACC” positions. The chime NOTE
stops when the key is removed from the Liquid-crystal displays are used in
ignition switch. some of the meters and gauges in the
combination meter. You will find their
Ignition switch light indications hard to see if you wear po-
For easy access to the ignition switch in larized glasses.
the dark, the ignition switch light comes on
when any of the doors are opened. The Combination meter illumina-
light remains on for a several seconds and tion
gradually goes out after all doors are
closed or if the key is inserted in the igni- 300177 When the ignition switch is turned to the
tion switch. “ON” position, the various parts of the
The hazard warning flasher is used to combination meter are illuminated in the
warn other drivers when you have to park following sequence:
your vehicle under emergency conditions. 1. Meter rims, gauge rims, warning lights,
The hazard warning flasher works with the and indicator lights light up.
ignition switch in any position. 2. Meter needles and gauge needles light
up.
To turn on the hazard warning flasher, 3. Meter needles and gauge needles
push the hazard warning button on the in- each show MAX position.
strument panel. To turn off the flasher, 4. Meter needles and gauge needles
push the button again.
each show MIN position.
NOTE 5. Dials in meters and gauges light up.
When the hazard warning flasher is on, 6. Regular illumination (for driving) be-
the turn signals do not work. gins.
– CONTINUED –
3-6 Instruments and controls
Canceling the function for To change the current setting, press the “LOCK” position, turn the ignition switch to
meter/gauge needle move- trip knob for at least two seconds. the “ON” position, or open and close the
driver’s door during the setting procedure,
ment and combination meter : Activated the new setting will be canceled.
sequential illumination upon : Deactivated Also, if you do not press the trip knob for a
turning on the ignition switch period of 10 seconds, the new setting will
be canceled.
NOTE
It is not possible to cancel sequential
illumination of the combination meter
while sequential illumination is actual-
ly taking place. Cancel sequential illu-
mination when regular illumination (for
driving) has begun.
300186 Speedometer
The speedometer shows the vehicle
300185 Briefly press the trip knob again. You can speed.
now establish the activated/deactivated
It is possible to activate or deactivate the setting for sequential illumination of the
movement of the meter needles and combination meter when the ignition
gauge needles and sequential illumination switch is turned to the “ON” position. To
of the combination meter that take place change the current setting, press the trip
when the ignition switch is turned to the knob for at least two seconds.
“ON” position.
Turn the ignition switch to the “ACC” posi- : Activated
tion. With the A trip meter indication se- : Deactivated
lected, briefly press the trip knob twice.
You can now establish the activated/deac- Briefly press the knob to return to the A trip
tivated setting for movement of the meter meter indication.
needles and gauge needles when the ig- If you turn the ignition switch to the
nition switch is turned to the “ON” position.
Instruments and controls 3-7
Odometer Double trip meter To set the trip meter to zero, select the A
trip or B trip meter by pushing the knob
and keep the knob pushed for more than
2 seconds.
If you press the trip knob when the ignition
switch is in the “LOCK” position, the
odometer/trip meter will light up. It is pos-
sible to switch between the A trip meter
and B trip meter indications while the
odometer/trip meter is lit up. If you do not
press the trip knob within 10 seconds of il-
lumination of the odometer/trip meter, the
300261 300258
odometer/trip meter will go off. Also, if you
open and close the driver’s door within 10
This meter displays the odometer when This meter display two trip meters when seconds of illumination of the odometer/
the ignition switch is in the “LOCK”, “ACC” the ignition switch is in the “LOCK”, “ACC” trip meter, the odometer/trip meter will go
or “ON” position. or “ON” position. off.
The odometer shows the total distance The trip meter shows the distance that the
that the vehicle has been driven. vehicle has been driven since you last set
it to zero.
If you press the trip knob when the ignition To change the mode indication, briefly To ensure safety, do not attempt to
switch is in the “LOCK” position, the push the knob. change the function of the indicator
odometer/trip meter will light up. If you do Each press of the knob changes the mode during driving, as an accident could
not press the trip knob within 10 seconds indication alternately. result.
of illumination of the odometer/trip meter,
the odometer/trip meter will go off.
A trip meter
NOTE
If the connection between the combi-
The odometer/trip meter will also go off if
nation meter and battery is broken for
you open and close the driver’s door with-
any reason such as vehicle mainte-
in 10 seconds of illumination of the odom-
nance or fuse replacement, the data re-
eter/trip meter. B trip meter
corded on the trip meter will be lost.
– CONTINUED –
3-8 Instruments and controls
T Vehicle communication system The gauge may move slightly during brak-
fault indication ing, turning or acceleration due to fuel lev-
The vehicle communication system car- Do not operate the engine with the el movement in the tank.
ries various types of information (vehicle pointer of the tachometer in the red If you press the trip knob while the ignition
speed, running conditions, etc.) to control zone. In this range, fuel injection will switch is in the “LOCK” position, the fuel
modules. In the event of a fault in this be cut by the engine control module gauge’s dial, needle, and rim will light up
communication system, the trip meter will to protect the engine from overrev- and the needle will indicate the amount of
show “ ”. ving. The engine will resume run- fuel remaining in the tank.
If the trip meter shows “ ”, immedi- ning normally after the engine If, while the fuel gauge needle is indicating
ately contact the nearest SUBARU dealer speed is reduced below the red the amount of fuel remaining in the tank,
and have the vehicle communication sys- zone. you (a) do not press the trip knob for 10
tem inspected. seconds or (b) open and close the driver’s
door, the fuel gauge needle will drop to the
NOTE Fuel gauge “E” position and the dial, needle, and rim
If you press the trip knob while the trip will go off.
meter is showing “ ”, the trip
meter indication will appear for 10 sec-
onds.
Tachometer
The tachometer shows the engine speed
in thousands of revolutions per minute.
300638
300639
The fuel gauge shows the approximate
amount of fuel remaining in the tank. The rim of the fuel gauge flashes five
When the ignition switch is in the “LOCK” times when the amount of remaining fuel
or “ACC” position, the fuel gauge shows reaches 2.6 US gal (10 liters, 2.2 lmp gal).
“E” even if the fuel tank contains fuel. If you turn the ignition switch to the
Instruments and controls 3-9
“LOCK” position and back to the “ON” po- tank is replenished up to an internal The coolant temperature will vary in ac-
sition, the rim will again flash five times. fuel quantity of approximately 4.0 US cordance with the outside temperature
gal (15 liters, 3.3 lmp gal). and driving conditions.
NOTE
We recommend that you drive moderately
until the pointer of the temperature gauge
Promptly put fuel in the tank when- reaches near the middle of the range. En-
ever the low fuel warning light gine operation is optimum with the engine
comes on. Engine misfires as a re- coolant at this temperature range and high
sult of an empty tank could cause revving operation when the engine is not
damage to the engine. warmed up enough should be avoided.
Temperature gauge
If the pointer exceeds the normal
operating range, safely stop the ve-
200253 hicle as soon as possible.
You will see the “ ” sign in the fuel See the “In case of emergency” in
gauge. chapter 9.
This indicates that the fuel filler door
(lid) is located on the right side of the
vehicle. 1
Odometer Double trip meter To set the trip meter to zero, select the A
trip or B trip meter by pushing the knob
and keep the knob pushed for more than
2 seconds.
If you press the trip knob when the ignition
switch is in the “LOCK” position, the
odometer/trip meter will light up. It is pos-
sible switch between the A trip meter and
B trip meter indications while the odome-
ter/trip meter is lit up. If you do not press
the trip knob within 10 seconds of illumina-
tion of the odometer/trip meter, the odom-
300261 300258
eter/trip meter will go off.
Also, if you open and close the driver’s
This meter displays the odometer when This meter displays the two trip meters door within 10 seconds of illumination of
the ignition switch is in the “LOCK”, “ACC” when the ignition switch is in the “LOCK”, the odometer/trip meter, the odometer/trip
or “ON” position. “ACC” or “ON” position. meter will go off.
The odometer shows the total distance The trip meter shows the distance that the
that the vehicle has been driven. vehicle has been driven since you last set
it to zero.
If you press the trip knob when the ignition To change the mode indication, briefly To ensure safety, do not attempt to
switch is in the “LOCK” position, the push the knob. change the function of the indicator
odometer/trip meter will light up. If you do Each press of the knob changes the mode during driving, as an accident could
not press the trip knob within 10 seconds indication alternately. result.
of illumination of the odometer/trip meter,
the odometer/trip meter will go off.
A trip meter
NOTE
Also, if you open and close the driver’s If the connection between the combi-
door within 10 seconds of illumination of nation meter and battery is broken for
the odometer/trip meter, the odometer/trip any reason such as vehicle mainte-
meter will go off. nance or fuse replacement, the data re-
B trip meter
corded on the trip meter will be lost.
– CONTINUED –
3-12 Instruments and controls
door, the fuel gauge needle will drop to the NOTE reaches near the middle of the range. En-
“E” position and the dial, needle, and rim This light does not go out unless the gine operation is optimum with the engine
will go off. tank is replenished up to an internal coolant at this temperature range and high
fuel quantity of approximately 4.0 US revving operation when the engine is not
NOTE warmed up enough should be avoided.
gal (15 liters, 3,3 lmp gal).
Temperature gauge
If the pointer exceeds the normal
operating range, safely stop the ve-
hicle as soon as possible.
See the “In case of emergency” in
chapter 9.
1
200253
has not yet fastened the seatbelt(s) when The warning light(s) for unfastened
the ignition switch is turned to the “ON” po- seatbelt(s) will alternate between
sition, the seatbelt warning light(s) will flashing and steady illumination at
flash for 6 seconds, to warn that the seat- 15-second intervals. The chime will
belt(s) is/are unfastened. If the driver’s not sound.
seatbelt is not fastened, a chime will also y At speeds higher than approxi-
sound simultaneously. mately 9 mph (15 km/h)
If the driver’s and/or front passenger’s The warning light(s) for unfastened
seatbelt(s) are/is still not fastened 6 sec- seatbelt(s) will alternate between
onds later, both warning lights or the flashing and steady illumination at
warning light for the unfastened seatbelt 15-second intervals and the chime
will remain lit for 15 seconds. If the driver’s will sound while the warning light(s)
100254
and/or front passenger’s seatbelt(s) are/is is/are flashing.
Driver’s warning light still not fastened even 15 seconds later y If you unfasten and refasten the driv-
(21 seconds after turning ON the ignition er’s seatbelt three times within six sec-
switch), the warning lights will alternate onds after turning ON the ignition
between flashing and steady illumination switch, the warning operation that fol-
at 15-second intervals, and the chime will lows the 6-second warning after turn-
sound while the warning light(s) is/are ing ON the ignition switch is canceled.
flashing. When the ignition switch is turned ON
Alternate flashing and steady illumination next time, however, the complete se-
of the warning lights and sounding of the quence of warning operations re-
chime will continue until both driver and sumes.
front passenger fasten their seatbelts.
If there is no passenger on the front pas-
NOTE senger’s seat, the seatbelt warning device
y If the driver and/or front passenger for the front passenger’s seat will be deac-
100662 unfasten(s) the seatbelt(s) after fasten- tivated. The front passenger’s occupant
ing, the seatbelt warning device oper- detection system monitors whether or not
Front passenger’s warning light there is a passenger on the front passen-
ates as follows according to the vehi-
T Operation cle speed. ger’s seat. Observe the following precau-
y At speeds lower than approximate- tions. Failure to do so may prevent the de-
If the driver and/or front passenger have/
ly 9 mph (15 km/h) vice from functioning correctly or cause
– CONTINUED –
3-16 Instruments and controls
the device to fail. moving the seat back and forth. (Models
y Do not install any accessory such as a equipped with manual seats only)
table or TV onto the seatback. If the warning light exhibits any of
y Do not store a heavy load in the seat- If still the seatbelt warning device for front
passenger’s seat does not function cor- the following conditions, there may
back pocket. be a malfunction in the seatbelt pre-
y Do not allow the rear seat occupant to rectly after taking relevant corrective ac-
tions described above, immediately con- tensioners and/or SRS airbag sys-
place his/her hands or legs on the front tem. Immediately take your vehicle
passenger’s seatback, or allow him/her to tact your SUBARU dealer for an inspec-
tion. to your nearest SUBARU dealer to
pull the seatback. have the system checked. Unless
y Do not use front seats with their back- checked and properly repaired, the
ward-forward position and seatback not SRS airbag system seatbelt pretensioners and/or SRS
being locked into place securely. If any of warning light airbags will operate improperly (e.g.
them are not locked securely, adjust them When the ignition switch is turned to the SRS airbags may inflate in a very mi-
again. For adjusting procedure, refer to “ON” position, the SRS airbag system nor collision or not inflate in a se-
the “Manual seat” in the front seats sec- warning light will come on for approxi- vere collision), which may increase
tion in chapter 1 in this owner’s manual. mately seven seconds and go out. This the risk of injury.
(Models equipped with manual seats only) shows the SRS frontal airbag and SRS y Flashing or flickering of the warn-
If the seatbelt warning device for the front side airbag and SRS curtain airbag and ing light
passenger’s seat does not function cor- seatbelt pretensioners are in normal oper-
ation. y No illumination of the warning
rectly (e.g., it is activated even when the light when the ignition switch is
front passenger’s seat is empty or it is de- first turned to the “ON” position
activated even when the front passenger
has not fastened his/her seatbelt), take y Continuous illumination of the
the following actions. warning light
y Ensure that no article is placed on the y Illumination of the warning light
seat other than a child restraint system while driving
and its child occupant.
y Ensure that there is no article left in the
seatback pocket.
y Ensure that the backward-forward posi-
tion and seatback of front passenger’s
seat are locked into place securely by
Instruments and controls 3-17
Front passenger’s frontal air- the status of the front passenger’s SRS CHECK ENGINE warn-
bag ON and OFF indicators frontal airbag determined by the Subaru ing light/Malfunction in-
advanced frontal airbag system monitor-
ing.
dicator lamp
If the front passenger’s SRS frontal airbag
is activated, the passenger’s frontal airbag
ON indicator will illuminate while the OFF
If the CHECK ENGINE light comes
indicator will remain extinguished.
on while you are driving, have your
If the front passenger’s SRS frontal airbag
vehicle checked/repaired by your
is deactivated, the passenger’s frontal air-
SUBARU dealer as soon as possi-
bag ON indicator will remain extinguished
ble. Continued vehicle operation
while the OFF indicator will illuminate.
without having the emission control
If both the ON and OFF indicators remain
system checked and repaired as
lit or extinguished simultaneously, the sys-
necessary could cause serious
100663 tem is faulty. Contact your SUBARU deal-
damage, which may not be covered
er immediately for an inspection.
or : Front passenger’s frontal air- by your vehicle’s warranty.
bag ON indicator
If this light comes on steadily or blinks
or : Front passenger’s frontal air-
bag OFF indicator while the engine is running, it may indicate
that there is a problem or potential prob-
The front passenger’s frontal airbag ON lem somewhere in the emission control
and OFF indicators show you the status of system.
the front passenger’s SRS frontal airbag.
T If the light comes on steadily:
The indicators are located between the
map lights. If the light comes on steadily while driving
When the ignition switch is turned to the or does not go out after the engine starts,
“ON” position, both the ON and OFF indi- an emission control system malfunction
cators illuminate for 6 seconds during has been detected.
which time the system is checked. Follow- You should have your vehicle checked by
ing the system check, both indicators ex- an authorized SUBARU dealer immedi-
tinguish for 2 seconds. After that, one of ately.
the indicators illuminates depending on
– CONTINUED –
3-18 Instruments and controls
NOTE The CHECK ENGINE warning light may is not working properly.
This light also comes on when the fuel stop blinking and come on steadily after If the light comes on while driving or does
filler cap is not tightened until it clicks. several driving trips. You should have not go out after the engine starts, stop the
your vehicle checked by an authorized engine at the first safe opportunity and
If you have recently refueled your vehicle, SUBARU dealer immediately. check the engine oil level. If the oil level is
the cause of the CHECK ENGINE warning low, add oil immediately. If the engine oil
light/malfunction indicator lamp coming on is at the proper level but the light remains
could be a loose or missing fuel filler cap.
Charge warning light
on, contact your nearest SUBARU dealer
Remove the cap and retighten it until it If this light comes on when the engine is immediately.
clicks. Make sure nothing is interfering running, it may indicate that the charging
with the sealing of the cap. Tightening the system is not working properly.
cap will not make the CHECK ENGINE
AT OIL TEMPerature
If the light comes on while driving or does warning light (AT vehi-
warning light turn off immediately. It may not go out after the engine starts, stop the
take several driving trips. If the light does engine at the first safe opportunity and
cles)
not go out, take your vehicle to your au- check the alternator belt. If the belt is The AT oil temperature warning light
thorized SUBARU dealer immediately. loose, broken or if the belt is in good con- comes on when the ignition switch is
T If the light is blinking: dition but the light remains on, contact turned to the “ON” position and goes out
your nearest SUBARU dealer immediate- after approximately two seconds.
If the light is blinking while driving, an en- If this light comes on when the engine is
ly.
gine misfire condition has been detected running, it may indicate that the automatic
which may damage the emission control transmission fluid temperature is too hot.
system. Oil pressure warning If the light comes on while driving, it is un-
To prevent serious damage to the emis- light necessary to stop the vehicle, but avoid
sion control system, you should do the fol- driving up steep grades or in stop and go
lowing. traffic.
y Reduce vehicle speed.
y Avoid hard acceleration. Do not operate the engine with the
y Avoid steep uphill grades. oil pressure warning light on. This Low tire pressure warn-
y Reduce the amount of cargo, if possi- may cause serious engine damage. ing light (if equipped)
ble. When the ignition switch is turned to the
y Stop towing a trailer as soon as possi- If this light comes on when the engine is “ON” position, the low tire pressure warn-
ble. running, it may indicate that the engine oil ing light will come on for approximately 2
pressure is low and the lubricating system
Instruments and controls 3-19
seconds to check that the tire pressure flation has not reached the level to trigger If this light comes on while driving,
monitoring system (TPMS) is functioning illumination of the TPMS low tire pressure never brake suddenly and keep driv-
properly. If there is no problem and all tires telltale. ing straight ahead while gradually
are properly inflated, the light will go out. The TPMS gives warning both when a tire reducing speed. Then slowly pull off
Each tire, including the spare (if provided), is significantly under-inflated and when the road to a safe place. Otherwise
should be checked monthly when cold there is a problem in the TPMS. The low an accident involving serious vehi-
and inflated to the inflation pressure rec- tire pressure warning light operates differ- cle damage and serious personal in-
ommended by the vehicle manufacturer ently according to these conditions as fol- jury could occur.
on the vehicle placard or tire inflation pres- lows:
sure label. (If your vehicle has tires of a When a tire is significantly under-inflat- If this light still comes on while driv-
different size than the size indicated on ed: Steady illumination ing after adjusting the tire pressure,
the vehicle placard or tire inflation pres- When there is a problem in the TPMS: a tire may have significant damage
sure label, you should determine the prop- Flashing and a fast leak that causes the tire to
er inflation pressure for those tires.) As an Should the warning light flash, have the lose air rapidly. If you have a flat
added safety feature, your vehicle has system inspected by your nearest tire, replace it with a spare tire as
been equipped with a tire pressure moni- SUBARU dealer as soon as possible. soon as possible.
toring system (TPMS) that illuminates a When a spare tire is mounted or a
low tire pressure telltale when one or more wheel rim is replaced without the
of your tires is significantly under-inflated. original pressure sensor/transmitter
Accordingly, when the low tire pressure If this light does not come on briefly being transferred, the Low tire pres-
telltale illuminates, you should stop and after the ignition switch is turned sure warning light will flash. This in-
check your tires as soon as possible, and ON or the light is flashing, you dicates the TPMS is unable to moni-
inflate them to the proper pressure. Driv- should have your Tire Pressure tor all four road wheels. Contact
ing on a significantly under-inflated tire Monitoring System checked at a your SUBARU dealer as soon as
causes the tire to overheat and can lead to SUBARU dealer as soon as possi- possible for tire and sensor replace-
tire failure. Under-inflation also reduces ble. ment and/or system resetting. If the
fuel efficiency and tire tread life, and may light flashes, promptly contact a
affect the vehicle’s handling and stopping SUBARU dealer to have the system
ability. Please note that the TPMS is not a inspected.
substitute for proper tire maintenance,
and it is the driver’s responsibility to main-
tain correct tire pressure, even if under-in-
– CONTINUED –
3-20 Instruments and controls
When the warning light is on, the ter the engine is started but goes out
ABS function shuts down; however, immediately, remaining off.
The tire pressure monitoring system the conventional brake system con- y The warning light remains on after
is NOT a substitute for manually tinues to operate normally. the engine has been started, but it goes
checking tire pressure. The tire out when the vehicle speed reaches
y The warning light does not come approximately 8 mph (12 km/h).
pressure should be checked period- on when the ignition switch is
ically (at least monthly) using a tire y The warning light comes on during
turned to the “ON” position. driving, but it goes out immediately
gauge. After any change to tire pres-
sure(s), the tire pressure monitoring y The warning light comes on when and remains off.
system will not re-check tire infla- the ignition switch is turned to the
“ON” position, but it does not go When driving with an insufficient battery
tion pressures until the vehicle is voltage such as when the engine is jump
first driven more than 20 mph (32 out even when the vehicle speed
exceeds approximately 8 mph (12 started, the ABS warning light may come
km/h). Be sure to install the speci- on. This is due to the low battery voltage
fied size for the front and rear tires. km/h).
and does not indicate a malfunction.
(U.S.) y The warning light comes on dur- When the battery becomes fully charged,
ABS warning light (Canada) ing driving. the light will go out.
The ABS warning light comes on when the If any of these conditions occur,
ignition switch is turned to the “ON” posi- have the ABS system repaired at Brake system (U.S.)
tion and goes out after approximately two the first available opportunity by warning light (Canada)
seconds. your SUBARU dealer.
This is an indication that the ABS system The ABS warning light comes on together
is working properly. with the brake system warning light if the
EBD system becomes faulty. For further y Driving with the brake system
details of the EBD system fault warning, warning light on is dangerous.
refer to “Brake system warning light”. This indicates your brake system
If the warning light behaves as fol- may not be working properly. If
lows, the ABS system may not work NOTE the light remains on, have the
properly. If the warning light behavior is as de- brakes inspected by a SUBARU
scribed in the following, the ABS sys- dealer immediately.
tem may be considered normal.
y The warning light comes on right af-
Instruments and controls 3-21
y If at all in doubt about whether the er for repair. been restarted, shut down the engine
brakes are operating properly, do again, apply the parking brake, and check
T Electronic Brake Force Distribution the brake fluid level.
not drive the vehicle. Have your (EBD) system warning
vehicle towed to the nearest 5. If the brake fluid level is not below the
The brake system warning light also illu- “MIN” mark, the EBD system may be
SUBARU dealer for repair.
minates if a malfunction occurs in the EBD faulty. Drive carefully to the nearest
This light has the following three func- system. In that event, it comes on together SUBARU dealer and have the system in-
tions: with the ABS warning light. spected.
The EBD system may be faulty if the brake 6. If the brake fluid level is below the
T Parking brake warning system warning light and ABS warning “MIN” mark, DO NOT drive the vehicle. In-
The light comes on with the parking brake light illuminate simultaneously during driv- stead, have the vehicle towed to the near-
applied while the ignition switch is in the ing. est SUBARU dealer for repair.
“ON” position. It goes out when the park- Even if the EBD system fails, the conven-
ing brake is fully released. tional braking system will still function.
However, the rear wheels will be more
Low fuel warning light
T Brake fluid level warning prone to locking when the brakes are ap- The low fuel warning light comes on when
This light comes on when the brake fluid plied harder than usual and the vehicle’s the tank is nearly empty approximately 2.6
level has dropped to near the “MIN” level motion may therefore become somewhat US gal (10.0 liters, or 2.2 Imp gal). It only
of the brake fluid reservoir with the ignition harder to control. operates when the ignition switch is in the
switch in the “ON” position and with the If the brake system warning light and ABS “ON” position.
parking brake fully released. warning light illuminate simultaneously, NOTE
If the brake system warning light should take the following steps: This light does not go out unless the
come on while driving (with the parking 1. Stop the vehicle in the nearest safe, flat
tank is replenished up to an internal
brake fully released and with the ignition place. fuel quantity of approximately 3.7 US
switch positioned in “ON”), it could be an 2. Shut down the engine, then restart it. gal (14 liters, 3.1 Imp gal).
indication of leaking of brake fluid or worn 3. Release the parking brake. If both
brake pads. If this occurs, immediately warning lights go out, the EBD system
stop the vehicle at the nearest safe place may be faulty.
and check the brake fluid level. If the fluid Drive carefully to the nearest SUBARU
level is below the “MIN” mark in the reser- dealer and have the system inspected.
voir, do not drive the vehicle. Have the ve- 4. If both warning lights come on again
hicle towed to the nearest SUBARU deal- and stay illuminated after the engine has
– CONTINUED –
3-22 Instruments and controls
The All-Wheel Drive warning light comes The Vehicle Dynamics Control system is
on when the ignition switch is turned to the probably faulty under any of the following
(Turbo model only) Promptly put “ON” position and goes out after the en- conditions. Have your vehicle checked at
fuel in the tank whenever the low gine has started. a SUBARU dealer immediately.
fuel warning light comes on. Engine y The light does not come on when the ig-
T For 5-speed automatic transmission nition switch is turned to the “ON” position.
misfires as a result of an empty tank vehicles
could cause damage to the engine. y The light does not go out even after a
This light flashes if the vehicle is driven period of approximately 2 seconds after
with tires of different diameters fitted on its the ignition switch has been turned to the
Door open warning light wheels or with the air pressure excessive- “ON” position.
When any of the doors or the rear gate ly low in any of its tires.
(Station wagon) or trunk lid (Sedan) is not T For 4-speed automatic transmission Vehicle Dynamics Con-
fully closed, it is indicated by the corre-
sponding part of the door warning light.
vehicles trol warning light (if
This light comes on when All-Wheel Drive equipped)/Vehicle Dy-
Always make sure this light is out before is disengaged and the drive mechanism is namics Control OFF indicator
you start to drive. switched to Front Wheel Drive for mainte-
nance or similar purposes.
light (if equipped)
This light flashes if the vehicle is driven This warning light has both the function of
All-Wheel Drive warn- indicating faults in the Vehicle Dynamics
with tires of different diameters fitted on its
ing light (AT vehicles) wheels or with the air pressure excessive- Control system and the function of indicat-
ly low in any of its tires. ing that the Vehicle Dynamics Control sys-
tem has been deactivated.
It comes on in the event of a fault in the
Continued driving with the AWD Vehicle Dynamics Con- system and is on when the system is not
warning light flashing can lead to trol operation indicator operating.
powertrain damage. If the AWD light (if equipped) This warning light comes on when the ig-
warning light flashes, promptly park nition switch is turned to the “ON” position
in a safe place then check whether This light comes on when the ignition
switch is ON and goes out approximately and goes out after the engine has started.
all four tires are the same diameter It indicates that the Vehicle Dynamics
and whether any of the tires has a 2 seconds later.
It blinks when the skid suppression func- Control system is in normal operation.
puncture or has lost air pressure for
some other reason. tion is activated. It illuminates when only
the traction control function is operating.
Instruments and controls 3-23
T Vehicle Dynamics Control warning tions of the brake system are still avail- should go out as soon as the engine
light able. You will be safe while driving with has warmed up.
The Vehicle Dynamics Control system is this condition, but have your vehicle y The indicator light comes on when
probably inoperative under any of the fol- checked at a SUBARU dealer as soon as the engine has developed a problem
lowing conditions. Have your vehicle possible. and the Malfunction indicator light is
checked at a SUBARU dealer immediate- on.
ly. NOTE
If the warning light behavior is as The Vehicle Dynamics Control system is
y The warning light does not come on probably faulty under the following condi-
when the ignition switch is turned to the shown in the following, the Vehicle Dy-
namics Control system may be consid- tion. Have your vehicle checked at a
“ON” position. SUBARU dealer as soon as possible.
y The warning light comes on while the ered normal.
y The warning light comes on right af- y The light does not go out even after the
vehicle is running. lapse of several minutes (the engine has
y If the electrical circuit of the Vehicle Dy- ter the engine is started but goes out
immediately, remaining off. warmed up) after the engine has started.
namics Control system itself becomes
faulty, the warning light only comes on. At y The warning light comes on after en-
this time, the ABS (Anti-lock Brake Sys- gine startup and goes off while the ve- Security indicator light
tem) remains fully operational. hicle is subsequently being driven. This indicator light shows the status of the
y The warning light comes on when the y The warning light comes on during alarm system. It also indicates operation
electronic control system of the ABS/Vehi- driving, but it goes out immediately of the immobilizer system.
cle Dynamics Control system becomes and remains off.
faulty. T Alarm system
T Vehicle Dynamics Control OFF indi-
The Vehicle Dynamics Control system cator light It blinks to show the driver the operational
provides its ABS control through the elec- status of the alarm system. For detailed
y It comes on when the Vehicle Dynamics information, refer to the “Alarm system”
trical circuit of the ABS system. Accord- Control OFF switch is pressed.
ingly, if the ABS is inoperative, the Vehicle section in chapter 2.
y It also comes on when the Vehicle Dy-
Dynamics Control system becomes un- namics Control system is deactivated. T Immobilizer system
able to provide ABS control. As a result,
This light blinks approximately 60 seconds
the Vehicle Dynamics Control system also NOTE after the ignition switch is turned from
becomes inoperative, causing the warning y The light may stay on for a while after
light to come on. Though both the Vehicle “ON” position to the “ACC” or “LOCK” po-
the engine has been started, especially
Dynamics Control and ABS systems are sition or immediately after the key is pulled
in cold weather. This does not indicate
inoperative in this case, the ordinary func- out. (Refer to the “Door locks” section in
the existence of a problem. The light
– CONTINUED –
3-24 Instruments and controls
chapter 2.) Selector lever position indi- Gear position indicator (AT
If the indicator light does not flash, it may cator (AT vehicles) vehicles)
indicate that immobilizer system may be
faulty. Contact your nearest SUBARU
dealer immediately.
In the event that an unauthorized key (for
example, an unauthorized duplicate) is
used, the security indicator light comes
on.
possible. Refer to the “Replacing bulbs” Cruise control set indica- Clock
section in chapter 11. tor light
The cruise control set indicator light NOTE
High beam indicator comes on when the ignition switch is If your vehicle is equipped with a navi-
light turned to the “ON” position and goes out gation system, refer to the separate
This light shows that the headlights are in after approximately three seconds. “Operating Instructions for Monitor
the high beam mode. This light comes on when vehicle speed System”.
This indicator light also comes on when has been set.
the headlight flasher is operated.
Headlight indicator light
Cruise control indica- This indicator light comes on when the
tor light light switch is turned to the “ ” posi-
The cruise control indicator light comes on tion (to turn on the parking lights) or to the
when the ignition switch is turned to the “ ” position (to turn on the headlights).
“ON” position and goes out after approxi-
mately three seconds. Front fog light indicator
This light comes on when the “CRUISE” light
main switch is pressed. This indicator light is on while the front fog
400257
NOTE lights are on.
If you move the cruise control lever or The clock shows the time while the igni-
press the main switch button while tion switch is in the “ACC” or “ON” posi-
turning the ignition switch “ON”, the tion.
cruise control function is deactivated
and the “CRUISE” indicator light flash-
es. To reactivate the cruise control
function, turn the ignition switch back
to the “ACC” or “LOCK” position, and
then turn it again to the “ON” position.
– CONTINUED –
3-26 Instruments and controls
300599 300600
To adjust the time shown by the clock, The clock will also show the time if you
press the “+” button or the “–” button. The press the “DISP” button while the ignition
indicated time will change in one-minute switch is in the “LOCK” position. It is pos-
increments. If you keep the button sible to adjust the time setting while the
pressed, the rate at which the indicated time is being shown. If you do not press
time changes will speed up. the “+” button or “–” button for 10 seconds
To reset the minutes to “00” with a radio while the time is being shown, the time in-
time signal, push the “SET” button. dication will go off.
300600
Also, the time indication will go off if you
open and close the driver’s door while the With the ignition switch in the “ON” posi-
time is being shown. tion, each successive push of the “DISP”
button toggles the display in the following
sequence:
To ensure safety, do not attempt to
set the time during driving, as an ac-
cident could result.
Instruments and controls 3-27
Canada-spec. vehicles
300595
The outside temperature indicator shows
U.S.-spec. vehicles
the outside temperature in a range from –
22 to 122°F (–30 to 50°C).
The indicator can give a false reading un-
der any of the following conditions:
y When there is too much sun.
y During idling; while running at low
300594 speeds in a traffic jam; when the engine is
restarted immediately following a shut-
U.S.-spec. vehicles down.
y When the actual outside temperature
falls outside the specified indicator range.
300268
Canada-spec. vehicles
– CONTINUED –
3-28 Instruments and controls
When the outside temperature drops to Current fuel consumption sumption at the present moment.
37°F (3°C) or lower, the temperature indi-
cation flashes to show that the road sur- Average fuel consumption
face may be frozen.
If the outside temperature drops to 37°F
(3°C) or lower while the display is giving
an indication other than the outside tem-
perature, the display switches to the out-
side temperature indication and flashes
for five seconds before returning to its
original indication.
If the display is already indicating an out-
side temperature of 37°F (3°C) or lower
when the ignition switch is turned to the 300270
“ON” position, the indication does not
flash. U.S.-spec. vehicles
300272
300596
Canada-spec. vehicles
This indication shows the average rate of The driving range indicates the distance
fuel consumption since the trip meter was that can be driven taking into account the
last reset. amount of fuel remaining in the tank and
Pressing the trip knob toggles the indica- the average rate of fuel consumption.
tion between the average fuel consump- When the low fuel warning light comes on,
tion corresponding to the A trip meter indi- the driving range indication flashes for five
cation and the average fuel consumption seconds. (The display first switches to the
corresponding to the B trip meter indica- driving range indication if it was originally
tion. giving some other indication.)
300274
When either of the trip meter indications is
reset, the corresponding average fuel U.S.-spec. vehicles
consumption value is also reset.
NOTE
y The indicated values vary in accor-
dance with changes in the vehicle’s
running conditions. Also, the indicated
values may differ slightly from the ac-
– CONTINUED –
3-30 Instruments and controls
Journey time
300275 400267
– CONTINUED –
3-32 Instruments and controls
Illumination brightness con- ward, the illumination brightness be- Parking light switch
comes the maximum and the automatic
trol dimming function does not work at all.
300178
300510
The parking light switch operates regard-
The brightness of clock display, audio, air less of the ignition switch position.
conditioner, information display and in- By pushing the front end of this switch, fol-
strument panel illumination dims when the lowing lights will come on.
light switch is in the “ ” or “ ” po- – Parking lights
sitions. You can adjust brightness of the – Front and rear side marker lights
instrument panel illumination for better – Tail lights
visibility. – License plate lights
In turbo models, you can also adjust the
brightness of the instrument panel illumi- To turn off, push the rear end of the park-
nation when the lighting switch is in the ing light switch.
OFF position. Avoid leaving these lights on for a long
To brighten, turn the control dial upward. time because that will run down the bat-
To darken, turn the control dial downward. tery.
NOTE
When the control dial is turned fully up-
3-34 Instruments and controls
y In freezing weather, be sure that y Use clean water if windshield move accumulations of road salt or
the wiper blades are not frozen to washer fluid is unavailable. In ar- road film. Keep the washer button de-
the windshield or rear window be- eas where water freezes in winter, pressed at least for 1 second so that
fore switching on the wipers. At- use SUBARU Windshield Washer washer solution will be sprinkled all
tempting to operate the wiper with Fluid or the equivalent. (See over the windshield or rear window.
the blades frozen to the window “Windshield washer fluid” section y Grease, wax, insects or other materi-
glass could cause not only the in chapter 11.) al on the windshield or the wiper
wiper blades to be damaged but Also, when driving the vehicle blades results in jerky wiper operation
also the wiper motor to burn out. If when there are freezing tempera- and streaking on the glass. If you can-
the wiper blades are frozen to the tures, use non-freezing type wiper not remove those streaks after operat-
window glass, be sure to operate blades. ing the washer or if the wiper operation
the defroster, wiper deicer (if is jerky, clean the outer surface of the
y Do not clean the wiper blades with windshield or rear window and the wip-
equipped) or rear window defog- gasoline or a solvent, such as
ger before turning on the wiper. er blades using a sponge or soft cloth
paint thinner or benzene. This will with a neutral detergent or mild-abra-
y If the wipers stop during opera- cause deterioration of the wiper sive cleaner. After cleaning, rinse the
tion because of ice or some other blades. window glass and wiper blades with
obstruction on the window, the clean water. The glass is clean if no
wiper motor could burn out even if NOTE beads form on the glass when you
the wiper switch is turned off. If y The front wiper motor is protected
rinse with water.
this occurs, promptly stop the ve- against overloads by a circuit breaker. y If you cannot eliminate the streaking
hicle in a safe place, turn the igni- If the motor operates continuously un-
even after following this procedure, re-
tion switch to the “LOCK” posi- der an unusually heavy load, the circuit
place the wiper blades with new ones.
tion and clean the window glass breaker may trip to stop the motor tem- Refer to the “Replacement of wiper
to allow proper wiper operation. porarily. If this happens, park your ve-
blades” section (chapter 11) for re-
hicle in a safe place, turn off the wiper
placement instructions.
switch, and wait for approximately 10
minutes. The circuit breaker will reset
itself, and the wipers will again operate Windshield wiper and washer
normally. switches
y Clean your wiper blades and window The wiper operates only when the ignition
glass periodically with a washer solu- switch is in the “ON” or “ACC” position.
tion to prevent streaking, and to re-
– CONTINUED –
3-36 Instruments and controls
T Windshield wipers T Mist (for a single wipe) T Wiper intermittent time control (if
equipped)
300286 300288
300287
OFF: Park For a single wipe of the wipers, pull the le-
: Intermittent ver toward you. The wipers operate until When the wiper switch is in the “ ” po-
LO: Low speed you release the lever. sition, turn the dial to adjust the operating
HI: High speed interval of the wiper.
To turn the wipers on, push the wiper con- The operating interval can be adjusted
trol lever down. continuously from the shortest interval to
the longest.
To turn the wipers off, return the lever to Two click stop positions of the dial may
the “OFF” position. help you to aim at your desired interval.
The operating interval can be adjusted in
nine steps.
Instruments and controls 3-37
T Washer Rear window wiper and wash- speed is low; shorter when the vehicle
er switch (Station wagon) speed is high).
When you subsequently move the selec-
tor lever of the automatic transmission to
the “R” position, the rear wiper will switch
to continuous operation. When you move
the selector lever from the “R” position to
some other position, the rear wiper will re-
turn to intermittent operation.
T Washer
To wash the rear window while the rear
wiper is operating, turn the knob on the
300289 end of the wiper control lever upward to
300290
the “ ” position. The washer fluid
To wash the windshield, push the washer sprays until you release the knob.
button at the end of the wiper control le- : Washer (accompanied by wiper opera- To wash the rear window when the rear
ver. The washer fluid sprays until you re- tion) wiper is not in use, turn the knob on the
lease the washer button. The wipers oper- ON: Continuous end of the wiper control lever downward to
ate while you push the button. INT: Intermittent the “ ” position. The washer fluid
OFF: Park sprays and the wiper operates until you
: Washer
release the knob.
T Rear wiper
To turn the rear wiper on, turn the knob on
the end of the wiper control lever upward
to the “INT” or “ON” position.
To turn the wiper off, return the knob on
the end of the lever to the “OFF” position.
With the switch turned to the “INT” posi-
tion, the rear wiper will operate intermit-
tently at intervals corresponding to the ve-
hicle speed (longer when the vehicle
3-38 Instruments and controls
Windshield wiper deicer (if “ACC” or “LOCK” position. If deicing is not Rear window defogger but-
complete, you have to push the button to
equipped) turn the deicer on again.
ton
Your SUBARU dealer can set your wind-
shield wiper deicer for continuous opera-
tion. Contact your SUBARU dealer for de-
tails.
Once the windshield wiper deicer has
been set for continuous operation, press-
ing the button results in continuous opera-
tion. The windshield wiper deicer automat-
ically stops operating if any one of the fol-
lowing conditions occurs during continu-
ous operation.
y The outside temperature becomes 41°F
300515 300291
(5°C) or higher.
The windshield wiper deicer operates only y The vehicle speed remains at 9 mph (15 Vehicle with manual climate control sys-
when the ignition switch is in the “ON” po- km/h) or lower for 15 minutes. tem
sition. y The battery voltage decreases below
the permissible level.
Before turning on the windshield wiper de-
icer, remove any snow from the wind-
shield. To turn on the windshield wiper de-
icer, push the button. The indicator light
located on the button lights up while the
windshield wiper deicer is operating.
The windshield wiper deicer will automati-
cally shut off after approximately 15 min-
utes. If the windshield wiper blades have
been deiced completely before that time,
push the button to turn it off. It also turns
off when the ignition switch is turned to the
Instruments and controls 3-39
1) Left button
2) Auto dimming indicator
3) Photosensor
4) Right button
300293
The auto-dimming mirror/compass has an
The inside mirror has a day and night po- anti-glare feature which automatically re-
sition. Pull the tab at the bottom of the mir- duces glare coming from headlights of ve-
ror toward you for the night position. Push hicles behind you. It also contains a built- 300518
it away for the day position. The night po- in compass.
The mirror has a photosensor attached on
sition reduces glare from headlights. y By pressing and releasing the left but-
both the front and back sides. If the glare
ton, the automatic dimming function is tog-
from the headlights of vehicles behind you
gled on or off. When the automatic dim-
strikes the mirror, these sensors detect it
ming function is on, the auto dimming indi-
and make the reflection surface of the mir-
cator light (green) located to the right of
ror dimmer to help prevent you from being
the button will illuminate.
blinded. For this reason, use care not to
y By pressing and releasing the right but-
Instruments and controls 3-41
cover the sensors with stickers, or other T Compass zone adjustment Outside mirrors
similar items. Periodically wipe the sen- 1. The zone setting is factory preset to
sors clean using a piece of dry soft cotton Zone 8. Refer to the “Compass calibration T Convex mirror (Passenger side)
cloth or an applicator. zone” map attached to the end of this
T Compass calibration manual to verify that the compass zone
setting is correct for your geographical lo-
1. For optimum calibration, switch off all Objects look smaller in a convex
cation.
nonessential electrical accessories (rear mirror and farther away than when
2. Press and hold the right button for 3
window defogger, heater/air conditioning viewed in a flat mirror. Do not use
seconds then release, and the word
system, spotlight, etc.) and ensure all the convex mirror to judge the dis-
“ZONE” will briefly appear and then the
doors are shut. tance of vehicles behind you when
zone number will be displayed.
2. Drive to an open, level area away from changing lanes. Use the inside mir-
3. Press the right-hand button repeatedly
large metallic objects or structures and ror (or glance backwards) to deter-
to cycle the display through all possible
make certain the ignition switch is in the mine the actual size and distance of
zone settings. Stop cycling when the cor-
“ON” position. objects that you view in convex mir-
rect zone setting for your location is dis-
3. Press and hold the left button for 3 sec- ror.
played.
onds then release, and the compass will
enter the calibration mode. “CAL” and di-
4. Releasing the button for 3 seconds will T Remote control mirror switch
exit the zone setting mode.
rection will be displayed.
4. Drive slowly in a circle until “CAL” dis-
appears from the display (approximately
two or three circles). The compass is now
calibrated.
5. Further calibration may be necessary
should outside influences cause the mirror
to read inaccurately. You will know that
this has occurred if your compass begins
to read in only limited directions. Should
you encounter this situation, return to step
one of the above procedure and recali- 300519
brate the mirror.
The remote control mirrors operate only
– CONTINUED –
3-42 Instruments and controls
when the ignition switch is in the “ON” or position. If defrosting or defogging is de-
“ACC” position. sired when you restart your vehicle, you
1. Turn the knob to the “L” side to adjust have to push the button to turn it on again.
the left-hand mirror or to the “R” side to ad-
just the right-hand mirror. NOTE
2. Move the knob in the direction you y While the outside mirror defogger is
want to move the mirror. operating, the rear window defogger
3. Return the knob to the neutral position also operates.
to prevent unintentional operation. y When the rear window defogger has
been set for continuous operation, the
The mirrors can also be adjusted manual- outside mirror defogger also operates
ly. continuously. Refer to the “Rear win-
300598 dow defogger button” section in this
T Outside mirror defogger (if
chapter.
equipped) Vehicle with automatic climate control
system
Vehicle with manual climate control sys- The defogger will automatically shut off af-
tem ter approximately 15 minutes. If the mirror
clears before that time, push the button to
turn it off. It also turns off when the ignition
switch is turned to the “ACC” or “LOCK”
Instruments and controls 3-43
300296
300295
Ventilator
Climate control
400341
Climate control 4-3
Center and side ventilators T Side ventilators Manual climate control sys-
T Center ventilators tem (if equipped)
1 Control panel
1 5 2 6 3
400578
400343 1) Open
2) Close 4
Move the tab up and down or right and left 400579
to adjust the flow direction. Move the tab up and down or right and left
to adjust the flow direction. 1) Temperature control dial
To open the ventilator, turn the side grille 2) Fan speed control dial
open/close wheel upward to the “ ” po- 3) Air flow control dial
sition. 4) Air conditioner button
To close it, turn the wheel downward to 5) Air inlet selection button
6) Rear window defogger button (Refer to
the “ ” position.
the “Rear window defogger button” sec-
tion in chapter 3.)
– CONTINUED –
4-4 Climate control
T Temperature control dial The fan operates only when the ignition
switch is turned to the “ON” position. The : Air flows through the instrument pan-
fan speed control dial is used to select four el outlets, the windshield defroster outlets,
fan speeds. and the foot outlets.
T Air flow control dial
: Air flows through the instrument
panel outlets and the windshield defroster
outlets.
NOTE
In a vehicle equipped with an air condi-
tioner, when the dial is placed in the
“ ” position or “ ” position the
400346
air conditioner compressor automati-
This dial regulates the temperature of air cally operates to quickly defog the
flow from the air outlets over a range from windshield. However the indicator on
the blue side (cool) to red side (warm). the air conditioner button will not come
400348 on. At the same time, the air inlet selec-
T Fan speed control dial tion is automatically set to “outside
This dial has the following five positions: air” mode.
In this state, you cannot select “recir-
: Air flows through the instrument pan- culation” mode by manually pressing
el outlets. the air inlet selection button.
Also, you cannot stop the air condi-
: Air flows through the instrument pan- tioner compressor by pressing the air
el outlets and the foot outlets. conditioner button.
Heater operation
T Defrosting or defogging the wind-
shield
400349 400350 To direct warm air to the windshield and
front door windows:
The air conditioner operates only when ON position (Recirculation): Interior air is 1. Set the air inlet selection button to the
the engine is running. recirculated inside the vehicle. OFF position.
Push the air inlet button to the ON posi- 2. Set the air flow control dial to the
Push the air conditioner button while the tion. The indicator light will come on. “ ” position.
fan is in operation to turn on the air condi- Place this button in the ON position when 3. Turn the temperature control dial all the
tioner. The indicator light will come on. you wish to cool the cabin quickly (in a ve- way to the right.
Push it again to turn off the air conditioner. hicle with an air conditioner) or are driving 4. Set the fan speed control dial to the
on a dusty road. highest speed.
OFF position (Outside air): Outside air is
drawn into the passenger compartment. NOTE
Push the air inlet button again to the OFF y In a vehicle equipped with an air con-
position. The indicator light will go off. ditioner, when the dial is placed in the
Place this button in the OFF position when “ ” position or “ ” position the
you reach a road that is not dusty and air conditioner compressor automati-
when you wish to achieve a comfortable cally operates to quickly defog the
temperature in the cabin. windshield. However the indicator on
the air conditioner button will not come
on. At the same time, the air inlet selec-
– CONTINUED –
4-6 Climate control
tion is automatically set to “outside the air conditioner button will not come T Bi-level heating
air” mode. on. At the same time, the air inlet selec- This setting allows you to direct air of dif-
In this state, you cannot select “recir- tion is automatically set to “outside ferent temperatures from the instrument
culation” mode by manually pressing air” mode. panel and foot outlets. The air from the
the air inlet selection button. In this state, you cannot select “recir- foot outlets is slightly warmer than from
Also, you cannot stop the air condi- culation” mode by manually pressing the instrument panel outlets.
tioner compressor by pressing the air the air inlet selection button. 1. Set the air inlet selection button to the
conditioner button. Also, you cannot stop the air condi- OFF position.
y Warm air also comes out from the tioner compressor by pressing the air 2. Set the air flow control dial to the
right and left air outlets. To stop warm conditioner button. “ ” position.
air flow from these outlets, turn the y Warm air also comes out from the 3. Set the temperature control dial to the
corresponding wheel to the “ ” po- right and left air outlets. To stop warm desired temperature level.
sition. air flow from these outlets, turn the 4. Set the fan speed control dial to the de-
corresponding wheel to the “ ” po- sired speed.
T Heating and defrosting sition.
To direct warm air toward the floor and the Setting the temperature control dial fully
windshield: T Heating turned to the red area or blue area de-
1. Set the air inlet selection lever to the To direct warm air toward the floor: creases the temperature difference be-
“OFF” position. 1. Set the air inlet selection button to the tween the air from the instrument panel
2. Set the air flow control dial to the OFF position. outlets and the air from the foot outlets.
“ ”position. 2. Set the air flow control dial to the
3. Set the temperature control dial to the “ ” position. T Ventilation
most comfortable level. 3. Set the temperature control dial to the To force outside air through the instru-
4. Set the fan speed control dial to the de- most comfortable level. ment panel outlets:
sired speed. 4. Set the fan speed control dial to the de- 1. Set the air inlet selection button to the
sired speed. OFF position.
NOTE 2. Set the air flow control dial to the “ ”
y In a vehicle equipped with an air con- NOTE position.
ditioner, when the dial is placed in the Warm air also comes out from the right 3. Set the temperature control dial all the
“ ” position or “ ” position the and left air outlets. To stop warm air way left.
air conditioner compressor automati- flow from these outlets, turn the corre- 4. Set the fan speed control dial to the de-
cally operates to quickly defog the sponding wheel to the “ ” position. sired speed.
windshield. However the indicator on
Climate control 4-7
When driving on a dusty road, set the air “ ” position. Automatic climate control
inlet control button to the ON position. 2. Set the temperature control dial to the
red side.
system (if equipped)
3. Set the fan speed control dial at the
highest speed. NOTE
Continued operation in the ON posi- y Operate the automatic climate con-
tion may fog up the windows. NOTE trol system when the engine is run-
Switch to the OFF position as soon In a vehicle equipped with an air condi- ning.
as the outside dusty condition tioner, when the dial is placed in the y The blower fan rotates at a low speed
clears. “ ” position or “ ” position the when the engine coolant temperature
air conditioner compressor automati- is low.
cally operates to quickly defog the For efficient defogging or dehumidify-
Air conditioner operation ing in cold weather, press the “A/C”
windshield. However the indicator on
T Cooling or dehumidifying the air conditioner button will not come button.
For cooling and dehumidification of the on. At the same time, the air inlet selec- y Even when cooling is not necessary,
passenger compartment, air flows through tion is automatically set to “outside setting the temperature much lower
the instrument panel outlets: air” mode. than the current outlet air temperature
1. Set the air inlet selection button to the In this state, you cannot select “recir- turns on the air conditioner compres-
OFF position. culation” mode by manually pressing sor automatically and the “A/C” indica-
2. Set the air flow control dial to the “ ” the air inlet selection button. tor light on the control panel comes on.
position. Also, you cannot stop the air condi-
The automatic climate control system au-
3. Set the air conditioner button to the tioner compressor by pressing the air
tomatically controls outlet air temperature,
“ON” position. conditioner button.
fan speed, air flow distribution air-inlet
4. Set the temperature control dial to the control, and air conditioner compressor
blue side. operation. It activates when the “AUTO”
5. Set the fan speed control dial at the de- button is pressed, and is used to maintain
sired speed. a constant, comfortable climate within the
T Defrosting or defogging passenger compartment.
The temperature can be set within a range
To direct warm air to the windshield and of 65 to 85°F (18 to 32°C).
front door windows:
1. Set the air outlet control dial to the
– CONTINUED –
4-8 Climate control
1 2 3 4
10 9 8 7 6 5
400580 400582
400581
1) AUTO button The Automatic Climate Control system
2) Temperature control dial (driver’s side) When the “AUTO” button is pressed, the turns off (the air conditioner compressor
3) Defroster button indicator light “AUTO” on the display and fan turn off) when the “OFF” button is
4) Temperature control dial (passenger’s comes on. In this state, fan speed, air flow pressed.
side) distribution, air-inlet control, and air condi- When the “OFF” button is pressed, the
5) Rear window defogger button (Refer to tioner compressor operation are automat- outside air introduction mode (air inlet se-
the “Rear window defogger button” sec-
tion in chapter 3.)
ically controlled. lection OFF) is automatically selected.
6) Air conditioner button Manual mode operation:
7) Air flow mode selection button If you operate any of the buttons on the
8) Fan speed control button
9) Air inlet selection button
control panel other than the “OFF” button
10)OFF button and temperature control dial during auto-
matic mode operation, the indicator light
“AUTO” on the control panel will go out.
You can then manually control the system
as desired using the button you operated.
To change the system back to the AUTO
mode, press the “AUTO” button.
Climate control 4-9
T Temperature control dial ture settings for the driver’s side and pas- ditioner is operating or not, outside air is
senger’s side. Each temperature setting is drawn into the passenger compartment,
shown on the display. With the dial set at the air conditioner compressor turns on,
your desired temperature, the system au- air flow is directed towards the windshield
tomatically adjusts the temperature of air and front door windows, and the indicator
supplied from the outlets such that the de- light on the button comes on.
sired temperature is achieved and main- After eliminating the fogging from the
tained. windshield, return the climate control sys-
If the dial is turned fully counterclockwise, tem to the AUTO mode by pushing the
the system gives maximum cooling perfor- “AUTO” button or turn off by pushing the
mance. If the dial is turned fully clockwise, “OFF” button.
the system gives maximum heating per- Alternatively, push the “ ” button
formance. again to return the system to the setting
400583 that was selected before you activated the
T – Defroster button defroster.
Driver’s side
T Fan speed control button
400585
400584
To defrost or dehumidify the windshield 400357
Passenger’s side and front door windows, push the defrost-
er button “ ”. When the “ ” button The fan speed control button has 6 differ-
It is possible to make separate tempera- is pushed, regardless whether the air con- ent fan speed positions.
– CONTINUED –
4-10 Climate control
The fan speed is shown by the display. T Air flow mode selection button er outlets, and the foot outlets.
T A/C – Air conditioner button T Air inlet selection button
400587
automatically. (There is one exception: Temperature sensors side of the driver-side part of the center
When the temperature control dial is panel
turned fully counterclockwise, the recircu- – Outside temperature sensor: behind
lation mode is automatically selected.) front grille.
When the outside air mode is selected, a
“ ” indicator light appears on the 1
display.
Operating tips for heater and low outside air to circulate into the heated any problem with the air conditioning sys-
interior. This results in quicker cooling by tem.
air conditioner the air conditioner. Keep the windows
closed during the operation of the air con- Air conditioner compressor
Cleaning ventilator grille ditioner for maximum cooling efficiency.
shut-off when engine is
heavily loaded
Lubrication oil circulation in
To improve acceleration and gas mileage,
the refrigerant circuit the air conditioner compressor is de-
Operate the air conditioner compressor at signed to temporarily shut off during air
a low engine speed (at idle or low driving conditioner operation whenever the accel-
speeds) a few minutes each month during erator is fully depressed such as during
the off-season to circulate its oil. rapid acceleration or when driving on a
steep upgrade.
Checking air conditioning
system before summer sea- Refrigerant for your climate
400590 son control system
Always keep the front ventilator inlet grille Check the air conditioner unit for refriger- Your air conditioner uses ozone friendly
free of snow, leaves, or other obstructions ant leaks, hose conditions, and proper op- refrigerant HFC134a. Therefore, the
to ensure efficient heating and defrosting. eration each spring. Have your SUBARU method of adding, changing or checking
Since the condenser is located in front of dealer perform this check. the refrigerant is different from the method
the radiator, this area should be kept for CFC12 (freon). Consult your SUBARU
clean because cooling performance is im- Cooling and dehumidifying in dealer for service. Repairs needed as a
result of using the wrong refrigerant are
paired by any accumulation of insects and high humidity and low tem- not covered under warranty.
leaves on the condenser. perature weather condition
Under certain weather conditions (high
Efficient cooling after parking relative humidity, low temperatures, etc.)
in direct sunlight a small amount of water vapor emission
After parking in direct sunlight, drive with from the air outlets may be noticed. This
the windows open for a few minutes to al- condition is normal and does not indicate
Climate control 4-13
Replacement schedule:
Every 12 months or 9,300 miles (15,000
km) whichever comes first
Station wagon
FM reception
Although FM is normally static free, recep-
tion can be affected by the surrounding ar-
ea, atmospheric conditions, station
strength and transmitter distance. Build-
ings or other obstructions may cause mo-
500035 mentary static, flutter or station interfer-
ence. If reception continues to be unsatis-
Sedan factory, switch to a stronger station.
Audio 5-3
LOAD
MP3 6 CD CHANGER P-203UE
LOAD
AM FM
CD
AM
RDM
AUDIO BAL RPT RDM AUDIO BAL RPT TEXT
FOLDER
SEEK TUNE
SCAN 1 2 3 4 5 6 TRACK
SEEK
1 2 3 4 5 6 TUNE
SCAN TRACK
P-201UN
500225 500226
PUSH POWER-VOL
CD
y Radio operation: refer to page 5-14 y Radio operation: refer to page 5-27
FM AM
y Built-in CD changer operation: refer to y Built-in CD changer operation: refer to
AUDIO BAL RPT RDM page 5-18 page 5-31
SEEK TUNE
SCAN 1 2 3 4 5 6 TRACK
500224
P-201UN
PUSH POWER-VOL
CD
FM AM
SEEK TUNE
SCAN 1 2 3 4 5 6 TRACK
500227
The audio set will operate only when the ignition switch is in the “ACC” or “ON” position.
Audio 5-5
Radio operation T Tone and balance control V To change tone control modes
AUDIO
500045 500229
500228 The volume control dial normally functions Each brief press of the “AUDIO” button
as a volume control. This dial becomes a changes control modes in the following
The dial is used for both power (ON/OFF) control for Bass, Midrange, Treble, Fader sequence starting from volume control
and volume control. The radio is turned or Balance when you select the appropri- mode. (When the radio is first turned on,
ON and OFF by pushing the dial and the ate tone and balance control mode. the control mode is in the volume control.)
volume is controlled by turning the dial. Choose desired volume level for each
The dial can also be used for tone and bal- mode by turning the volume control dial. Volume Bass Midrange
ance adjustment. The control function returns to volume (VOLUME) (BASS) (MIDDLE)
control mode after approximately 5 sec-
onds. Treble
(TREBLE)
– CONTINUED –
5-6 Audio
BAL
500009
500230
Turn counterclockwise Turn clockwise
Bass control (–6 to +6) For less bass sound For more bass sound
Each brief press of the “BAL” button
changes control modes in the following
Midrange control (–6 to +6) For less midrange sound For more midrange sound sequence starting from volume control
mode. (When the radio is first turned on,
Treble control (–6 to +6) For less treble sound For more treble sound the control mode is in the volume control.)
Volume control (0 to 40) For less volume For more volume
Volume Fader Balance
(VOLUME) (FADER) (BALANCE)
CD
FM AM
500009
500231
Turn counterclockwise Turn clockwise
Fader control (R9 to F9) To increase rear speaker volume To increase front speaker volume
Push the “FM” or “AM” button when the ra-
and decrease front speaker vol- and decrease rear speaker vol- dio is off to turn on the radio.
ume ume Push the “FM” or “AM” button when the ra-
dio is on to select FM1, FM2 or AM recep-
Balance control (L9 to R9) To increase left speaker volume To increase right speaker volume tion.
and decrease right speaker vol- and decrease left speaker vol-
ume ume T Stereo indicator
The stereo indicator “ST” will come on
Volume control (0 to 40) For less volume For more volume when an FM stereo broadcast is received.
– CONTINUED –
5-8 Audio
SEEK 500232
500049
SCAN If you press the “ ” or “
SEEK/SCAN button for 1.5 second or
” side of the
Press the “ ” side of the TUNE/TRACK longer, the radio will switch to scan mode.
button to increase the tuning frequency In this mode, the radio scans through the
and press the “ ” side of the button to radio band until a station is found. The ra-
decrease it. dio will stop at the station for five seconds
500232
Each time the button is pressed, the fre- while displaying the frequency, after which
quency interval can be changed between If you press the “ ” or “ ” side of the scanning will continue until the entire band
10 kHz in the AM mode and 0.2 MHz in the SEEK/SCAN button and release it within has been scanned.
FM mode. 1.5 second, the radio will automatically Press the “ ” or “ ” side of the button
If you hold down the “ ” side of the but- search for a receivable station and stop at again to cancel the scan mode and to stop
ton, the tuning frequency will increase the first one it finds. This function may not on any displayed frequency.
continuously, and if you hold down the be available, however, when radio signals If you hold down the “ ” side of the but-
“ ” side of the button, the tuning fre- are weak. In such a situation, perform ton, the radio will scan up the frequency
quency will decrease continuously. Re- manual tuning to select the desired sta- band (from low frequencies to high fre-
lease the button when your desired fre- tion. quencies). If you hold down the “ ” side
quency is reached. of the button, the radio will scan down the
frequency band (from high frequencies to
Audio 5-9
low frequencies). more than 1.5 seconds to store the fre- TIME.
Automatic tuning may not function proper- quency. If the button is pressed for less y Be sure to always insert a disc with
ly if the station reception is weakened by than 1.5 seconds, the preceding selection the label side up. If a disc is inserted
distance from the station or proximity to will remain in memory. with the label side down, it might be
tall buildings and hills. ejected or the player might shut off.
NOTE y After the last song finishes, the play-
T Selecting preset stations y If the connection between the radio er will automatically return to track 1
and battery is broken for any reason (the first song on the disc).
such as vehicle maintenance or radio y If you insert a disc that the player
removal, all stations stored in the pre- cannot read, the player will eject the
set buttons are cleared. If this occurs, disc and revert to its previous mode.
it is necessary to reset the preset but- y The player is designed to be able to
tons. play music CD-Rs and music CD-RWs,
1 2 3 4 5 6 y If a cell phone is placed near the ra- but it may not be able to play certain
dio, it may cause the radio to emit ones.
noise when it receives calls. This noise
does not indicate a radio fault. V When CD is in the player
TUNE
TRACK RPT
RDM
500057 500235
Press the “ ” side of the TUNE/TRACK Use this to play a certain track repeatedly.
button continuously to fast-reverse the During playback, press the “RPT” button.
disc. The “RPT” indicator will come on and the 500236
Release the button to stop fast-reversing. track will be played continuously. To can-
cel the repeat mode, press the button Use this to play the tracks on the disc in
NOTE again. Then the “RPT” indicator goes out, random order. During playback, press the
If you fast-reverse to the beginning of and normal playback mode is restored. “RDM” button. The “RDM” indicator will
the first track on the disc, the fast-re- come on and all songs on the disc will be
versing will stop and the player will NOTE played in a random order.
start playing the first track on the disc. The repeat-playback mode will be can- To cancel the random mode, press the
celled if you perform any of the follow- button again. Then the “RDM” indicator
ing operations: goes out, and normal playback mode is
y Press the “RDM” button restored.
y Press the “ ” or “ ” side of the
SEEK/SCAN button NOTE
y Press the “ ” button The random-playback mode will be
y Select the radio mode cancelled if you perform any of the fol-
y Turn off the power of the audio lowing operations:
– CONTINUED –
5-12 Audio
y Press the “RPT” button ward beginning with the track preceding T To eject a disc from the player
y Press the “ ” or “ ” side of the the currently selected one. After all tracks
SEEK/SCAN button on the disc has been scanned, normal
y Press the “ ” button playback mode is restored.
y Select the radio mode To cancel a scan, press the “ ” or “ ”
y Turn off the power of the audio side of the button again.
equipment.
y Turn the ignition switch to the “OFF” NOTE
position. The scan mode will be cancelled if you
perform any of the following opera-
T Scan tions:
y Press the “RPT” button
y Press the “RDM” button
y Press the “ ” button 500237
y Press the “ ” or “ ” side of the
TUNE/TRACK button When a disc is being played back or when
y Select the radio mode a disc is in the player, press the eject but-
SEEK y Turn off the power of the audio ton “ ”. The disc will be ejected.
SCAN equipment.
NOTE
y Turn the ignition switch to the “OFF”
y Avoid driving the vehicle with a CD
position.
sticking out, because vibration might
make it fall out.
500232 y If the disc is left ejected for more
than approximately 15 seconds after
The scan mode lets you listen to the first the ignition switch is turned to the
10 seconds of each track on the disc in “OFF” position, a disc protection func-
succession. Press the “ ” side of the tion will operate, automatically reload-
SEEK/SCAN button to start scanning ing the disc. In this case, the disc is not
through all tracks upward beginning with played.
the track following the currently selected
one. Press the “ ” side of the button to
start scanning through all tracks down-
Audio 5-13
6 CD CHANGER P-203UH
LOAD
PUSH POWER-VOL
CD
FM AM
SEEK TUNE
SCAN 1 2 3 4 5 6 TRACK
500238
The radio will operate only when the ignition switch is in the “ACC” or “ON” position.
– CONTINUED –
5-14 Audio
500229
500045
To change tone control modes: Each
The volume control dial normally functions brief press of the “AUDIO” button changes
as a volume control. This dial becomes a control modes in the following sequence
control for Bass, Midrange, Treble, Fader starting from volume control mode. (When
500228
or Balance when you select the appropri- the radio is first turned on, the control
ate tone and balance control mode. mode is in the volume control.)
The dial is used for both power (ON/OFF)
and volume control. The radio is turned Choose desired volume level for each
mode by turning the volume control dial. Volume Bass Midrange
ON and OFF by pushing the dial and the
The control function returns to volume (VOLUME) (BASS) (MIDDLE)
volume is controlled by turning the dial.
control mode after approximately 5 sec-
onds. Treble
(TREBLE)
BAL
500009
500230
Turn counterclockwise Turn clockwise
Bass control (–6 to +6) For less bass sound For more bass sound
Each brief press of the “BAL” button
changes control modes in the following
Midrange control (–6 to +6) For less midrange sound For more midrange sound sequence starting from volume control
mode. (When the radio is turned on, the
Treble control (–6 to +6) For less treble sound For more treble sound control mode is in the volume control.)
Volume control (0 to 40) For less volume For more volume
Volume Fader Balance
(VOLUME) (FADER) (BALANCE)
– CONTINUED –
5-16 Audio
CD
FM AM
500009
500231
Turn counterclockwise Turn clockwise
Fader control (R9 to F9) To increase rear speaker volume To increase front speaker volume
Push the “FM” or “AM” button when the ra-
and decrease front speaker vol- and decrease rear speaker vol- dio is off to turn on the radio.
ume ume Push the “FM” or “AM” button when the ra-
dio is on to select FM1, FM2 or AM recep-
Balance control (L9 to R9) To increase left speaker volume To increase right speaker volume tion.
and decrease right speaker vol- and decrease left speaker vol-
ume ume T Stereo indicator
The stereo indicator “ST” will come on
Volume control (0 to 40) For less volume For more volume when an FM stereo broadcast is received.
Audio 5-17
SEEK 500232
500049
SCAN If you press the “ ” or “
SEEK/SCAN button for 1.5 second or
” side of the
Push the “ ” side of the TUNE/TRACK longer, the radio will switch to scan mode.
button to increase the tuning frequency In this mode, the radio scans through the
and press the “ ” side of the button to radio band until a station is found. The ra-
decrease it. dio will stop at the station for five seconds
500232
Each time the button is pressed, the fre- while displaying the frequency, after which
quency interval can be changed between If you press the “ ” or “ ” side of the scanning will continue until the entire band
10 KHz in the AM mode and 0.2 MHz in SEEK/SCAN button and release it within has been scanned from the low end to the
the FM mode. 1.5 second, the radio will automatically high end.
If you hold down the “ ” side of the but- search for a receivable station and stop at Press the “ ” or “ ” side of the button
ton, the tuning frequency will increase the first one it finds. This function may not again to cancel the scan mode and to stop
continuously, and if you hold down the be available, however, when radio signals on any displayed frequency.
“ ” side of the button, the tuning fre- are weak. In such a situation, perform If you hold down the “ ” side of the but-
quency will decrease continuously. Re- manual tuning to select the desired sta- ton, the radio will scan up the frequency
lease the button when your desired fre- tion. band (from low frequencies to high fre-
quency is reached. quencies). If you hold down the “ ” side
of the button, the radio will scan down the
– CONTINUED –
5-18 Audio
frequency band (from high frequencies to 3. Press one of the preset buttons for at ones.
low frequencies). least 1.5 seconds to store the frequency.
Automatic tuning may not function proper- The frequency of the station will flash T How to insert a CD(s)
ly if the station reception is weakened by once on the display at this time. If the but- V Inserting a CD
distance from the station or proximity to ton is pressed for less than 1.5 seconds, 0
peat Steps 1 and 2. The magazine will be tion where you can insert a disc, the disc ton, the player will begin to play back the
loaded with discs in the ascending order number indicator associated with the idle first track of the last disc you have insert-
of position number. position will blink. ed.
If you do not insert any disc in 15 seconds The positions in the magazine the indica- y While the player is in the loading mode,
after you have pressed the “LOAD” but- tor of which steadily lights up are already if you press the “FM” or “AM” button, the
ton, the player will begin to play back the loaded with discs. player will enter standby mode. Press the
first track of the last disc you have insert- “CD” button to start playback.
ed.
y The disc indicator steadily lights up if a V Loading all the magazine (Full disc
disc is already inserted in the correspond- loading mode)
0
and will steadily light. V When there are CDs loaded: T To select a song from its beginning
3. When the loading of a disc is complete,
the next disc number indicator will blink. V Forward direction
Then repeat Step 2.
4. When the magazine is filled with discs
by repeating Steps 2 and 3, the player will
start playback of the discs, beginning with
the one inserted first. 1 2 3 4 5 6
TUNE
If you fail to insert any disc during each 15- TRACK
second interval, the full disc loading mode
will be canceled, and the player will start
playback of the disc inserted first.
500233
T How to play back a CD or make a
pause Press a desired one of the “Disc select” 500056
TUNE TUNE
TRACK TRACK
TUNE
TRACK
500057 500057
Briefly press the “ ” side of the TUNE/ 500056 Press the “ ” side of the TUNE/TRACK
TRACK button to skip to the beginning of button continuously to fast-reverse the
the current track. Each time the button is Press the “ ” side of the TUNE/TRACK disc.
pressed, the indicated track number will button continuously to fast-forward the Release the button to stop fast-reversing.
decrease. disc.
Release the button to stop fast-forward- NOTE
ing. If you fast-reverse to the beginning of
the first track on the disc, the fast-re-
NOTE versing will stop and the player will
If you fast-forward past the last track start playing the first track on the disc.
on the disc, the player will select the
first track on the disc and start playing
it.
– CONTINUED –
5-22 Audio
T Repeat playback If you accidentally press the button V To repeat the currently playing disc
and cancel the track-repeat-play mode,
V To repeat the currently playing track press it again to reselect the repeat
play mode.
y If you perform a fast-forward or fast-
reverse operation while the player is in
repeat-play mode, the repeat-play
mode will remain active even after you RPT
skip tracks.
RPT y If you perform a forward-direction or
backward-direction skip operation
while the player is in repeat-play mode,
the player will jump to the following/
previous track but the repeat-play 500235
mode will remain active.
500235 To repeat the currently playing CD, press
y The repeat-play mode will be can-
the “RPT” button twice while a track is
To repeat a track, press the “RPT” button celled if you perform any of the follow-
playing. The display will show “D-RPT”,
while the track is playing. The display will ing steps:
and the CD will be played repeatedly.
show “RPT”, and the track will be repeat- y Press the “ ” or “ ” side of
To cancel the disc repeat-play mode,
ed. the SEEK/SCAN button
press the “RPT” button once more. The
To cancel the track-repeat-play mode, y Press the “RPT” button.
“D-RPT” indication will go off, and the nor-
press the “RPT” button twice. The “RPT” y Press the “RDM” button
mal playback mode will be resumed.
indication will go off, and the normal play- y Press the “ ” button
back mode will be resumed. y Press the disc select button NOTE
y Select the radio mode y Each time you briefly press the but-
NOTE y Turn off the power of the audio ton, the mode will change to the next
y Each time you press the button, the equipment. one in the following sequence.
mode will change to the next one in the y Turn the ignition switch to the
following sequence. “OFF” position. RPT D-RPT CANCEL
RPT D-RPT CANCEL
If you accidentally press the button
Audio 5-23
and cancel the disc-repeat-play mode, Press the “RDM” button while a disc is be- the random playback mode.
press it again to reselect the disc-re- ing played back to play all of the tracks on y If you perform a forward direction
peat-play mode. the disc in a random order. The “RDM” in- skip while a track is being played in the
y The disc-repeat-play mode will be dicator will come on and all songs on the random playback mode, the player will
cancelled if you perform any of the fol- disc will be played in a random order. random select another track and play
lowing steps: To cancel the random mode, press the it. If you perform a backward direction
y Press the “ ” or “ ” side of button again. Then the “RDM” indicator skip, the disc will return to the begin-
the SEEK/SCAN button goes out, and normal playback mode is ning of the currently playing track.
y Press the “RPT” button. restored.
y Press the “RDM” button T Scan
y Press the “ ” button NOTE
y Press the disc select button y Random playback will be cancelled if
y Select the radio mode you perform any of the following steps:
y Turn off the power of the audio y Press the “RPT” button
equipment. y Press the “ ” or “ ” side of
y Turn the ignition switch to the the SEEK/SCAN button
y Press the “ ” button
SEEK
“OFF” position.
y Press the disc select button SCAN
T Random playback y Select the radio mode
y Turn off the power of the audio
equipment.
y Turn the ignition switch to the
“OFF” position. 500232
the currently selected one. After all tracks number indicator will go off.
0
LOAD
PUSH POWER-VOL
CD
FM AM
RDM
AUDIO BAL RPT TEXT
FOLDER
SEEK TUNE
SCAN 1 2 3 4 5 6 TRACK
500240
The audio set will operate only when the ignition switch is in the “ACC” or “ON” positions.
Audio 5-27
Radio operation T Tone and balance control V To change tone control modes
AUDIO
500045 500229
500228 The volume control dial normally functions Each brief press of the “AUDIO” button
as a volume control. This dial becomes a changes control modes in the following
The dial is used for both power (ON/OFF) control for Bass, Midrange, Treble, Fader sequence starting from volume control
and volume control. The radio is turned or Balance when you select the appropri- mode. (When the radio is first turned on,
ON and OFF by pushing the dial and the ate tone and balance control mode. the control mode is in the volume control.)
volume is controlled by turning the dial. Choose desired volume level for each
The dial can also be used for tone and bal- mode by turning the volume control dial. Volume Bass Midrange
ance adjustment. The control function returns to volume (VOLUME) (BASS) (MIDDLE)
control mode after approximately 5 sec-
onds. Treble
(TREBLE)
– CONTINUED –
5-28 Audio
BAL
500009
500230
Turn counterclockwise Turn clockwise
Bass control (–6 to +6) For less bass sound For more bass sound
Each brief press of the “BAL” button
changes control modes in the following
Midrange control (–6 to +6) For less midrange sound For more midrange sound sequence starting from volume control
mode. (When the radio is first turned on,
Treble control (–6 to +6) For less treble sound For more treble sound the control mode is in the volume control.)
Volume control (0 to 40) For less volume For more volume
Volume Fader Balance
(VOLUME) (FADER) (BALANCE)
CD
FM AM
500009
500231
Turn counterclockwise Turn clockwise
Fader control (R9 to F9) To increase rear speaker volume To increase front speaker volume
Push the “FM” or “AM” button when the ra-
and decrease front speaker vol- and decrease rear speaker vol- dio is off to turn on the radio.
ume ume Push the “FM” or “AM” button when the ra-
dio is on to select FM1, FM2 or AM recep-
Balance control (L9 to R9) To increase left speaker volume To increase right speaker volume tion.
and decrease right speaker vol- and decrease left speaker vol-
ume ume T Stereo indicator
The stereo indicator “ST” will come on
Volume control (0 to 40) For less volume For more volume when an FM stereo broadcast is received.
– CONTINUED –
5-30 Audio
SEEK 500232
500049
SCAN If you press the “ ” or “
SEEK/SCAN button for 1.5 second or
” side of the
Press the “ ” side of the TUNE/TRACK longer, the radio will switch to scan mode.
button to increase the tuning frequency In this mode, the radio scans through the
and press the tuning button marked “ ” radio band until a station is found. The ra-
to decrease it. dio will stop at the station for five seconds
500232
Each time the button is pressed, the fre- while displaying the frequency, after which
quency interval can be changed between If you press the “ ” or “ ” side of the scanning will continue until the entire band
10 kHz in the AM mode and 0.2 MHz in the SEEK/SCAN button and release it within has been scanned.
FM mode. 1.5 second, the radio will automatically Press the “ ” or “ ” side of the button
If you hold down the “ ” side of the but- search for a receivable station and stop at again to cancel the scan mode and to stop
ton, the tuning frequency will increase the first one it finds. This function may not on any displayed frequency.
continuously, and if you hold down the be available, however, when radio signals If you hold down the “ ” side of the but-
“ ” side of the button, the tuning fre- are weak. In such a situation, perform ton, the radio will scan up the frequency
quency will decrease continuously. Re- manual tuning to select the desired sta- band (from low frequencies to high fre-
lease the button when your desired fre- tion. quencies). If you hold down the “ ” side
quency is reached. of the button, the radio will scan down the
frequency band (from high frequencies to
Audio 5-31
low frequencies). more than 1.5 seconds to store the fre- matically play back.
Automatic tuning may not function proper- quency. If the button is pressed for less y The player is designed to be able to
ly if the station reception is weakened by than 1.5 seconds, the preceding selection play music CD-Rs and music CD-RWs,
distance from the station or proximity to will remain in memory. but it may not be able to play certain
tall buildings and hills. ones.
NOTE y Single CDs (i.e., 8 cm/3 inch CDs) are
T Selecting preset stations y If the connection between the radio not supported, and if inserted, they will
and battery is broken for any reason be immediately ejected.
such as vehicle maintenance or radio
removal, all stations stored in the pre- T How to insert a CD(s)
set buttons are cleared. If this occurs, V Inserting a CD
it is necessary to reset the preset but- 0
tons.
1 2 3 4 5 6 y If a cell phone is placed near the ra-
dio, it may cause the radio to emit
noise when it receives calls. This noise
does not indicate a radio fault.
– CONTINUED –
5-32 Audio
2. When the “LOAD” indicator flashes, in- V Inserting a disc in a desired position
sert the disc. Once you have inserted the 0
button to start playback. start playback of the discs, beginning with buttons the disc number indicator of which
the one inserted first. steadily lights up. The player will then start
V Loading all the magazine (Full disc playback of the selected CD, beginning
loading mode) If you fail to insert any disc during each 15 with the first track.
0
seconds interval, the full disc loading If a disc that the player cannot read has
mode will be canceled, and the player will been loaded, the player will eject that disc
start playback of the disc inserted first. and proceed to the next disc.
T How to play back a CD or make a T To select a song from its beginning
pause
V Forward direction
LOAD V When there is no CD inserted:
Insert a CD by referring to “How to insert a
CD(s)”.
When a CD is loaded, the player will start
playback of the CD, beginning with the
500239
first track.
TUNE
V When there are CDs loaded: TRACK
1. If you continue to press the “LOAD”
button for more than 1.5 seconds, the
player will produce beep sound and will
enter the full disc loading mode.
2. When the disc number indicator and
“ALL LOAD” indicator start flashing, insert 500056
a disc within 15 seconds. If a disc is suc-
cessfully loaded during this period, the 1 2 3 4 5 6 Briefly press the “ ” side of the TUNE/
disc number indicator will stop blinking TRACK button to skip to the beginning of
and will steadily light. the next track/file (track). Each time the
3. When the loading of a disc is complete, button is pressed, the indicated track/file
the next disc number indicator will blink. (track) number will increase.
Then repeat Step 2. 500233 NOTE
4. When the magazine is filled with discs In an MP3 folder, skipping past the last
by repeating Steps 2 and 3, the player will Press a desired one of the “Disc select” track/file (track) will take you back to
– CONTINUED –
5-34 Audio
the first track/file (track) in the folder. T Fast-forwarding and fast-reversing V Fast-reversing
V Backward direction V Fast-forwarding
TUNE
TRACK
TUNE TUNE
TRACK TRACK
500057
– CONTINUED –
5-36 Audio
If you accidentally press the button Press the “RPT” button briefly during disc/ T Auto tuning (scan mode)
and cancel the disc/folder repeat-play folder playback to play all of the tracks/
mode, press it again to reselect the files (tracks) on the disc/folder in a random
disc/folder repeat-play mode. order. The display will show “RDM”, and
y The disc/folder repeat-play mode will all of the tracks on the disc/folder will be
be cancelled if you perform any of the played in a random order.
following steps: To cancel random playback, press the
y Press the “RPT” button “RPT” button again for at least 1.5 second.
SEEK
y Press the “ ” button The “RDM” indication will go off, and the SCAN
y Press the disc select button normal playback mode will be resumed.
y Select the radio mode
y Press the “ ” or “ ” side of NOTE
the SEEK/SCAN button Random playback will be cancelled if
y Turn off the power of the audio you perform any of the following steps: 500232
equipment. y Press the “RPT” button
y Press the “ ” or “ ” side of the The scan mode lets you listen to the first
y Turn the ignition switch to the
SEEK/SCAN button 10 seconds of each track/file (track) in
“OFF” position.
y Press the “ ” button succession. Press the “ ” side of the
T Random playback y Press the disc select button SEEK/SCAN button for 1.5 second or
y Select the radio mode longer to start scanning upward beginning
y Turn off the power of the audio with the track/file (track) following the cur-
equipment. rently selected one. Press the “ ” side
y Turn the ignition switch to the “OFF” of the button to start scanning downward
beginning with the track/file (track) pre-
RDM position.
ceding the currently selected one. When
all tracks/files (tracks) in the disk/folder
RPT have been scanned, normal playback will
be resumed. To cancel the scan mode,
press the “ ” or “ ” side of the button
for 1.5 second or longer.
500241 NOTE
The scan mode will be cancelled if you
Audio 5-37
– CONTINUED –
5-38 Audio
T How to unload CDs from the player V Ejecting all discs from the player
(All disc ejection mode)
V Ejecting a CD from the player 0
1 2 3 4 5 6
500237
NOTE
y Avoid driving the vehicle with a CD
sticking out, because vibration might
make it fall out.
y If you press the “ ” button while
the player is in all disc ejection mode,
Audio 5-39
the mode will be cancelled following Audio control buttons (if T“ ” and “ ” buttons
ejection of the disc that is currently be-
ing ejected.
equipped)
y If you press the “CD” button while
These buttons are located on the spokes
the player is in all disc ejection mode,
of the steering wheel. They allow the driv-
the player will draw in the discs that
er to control audio functions without taking
have been ejected and play them.
his/her hands off the steering wheel.
T MODE button
400217
400218 400219
Press the “+” button to increase the vol- Press this button if you wish to immediate-
ume. Press the “–” button to reduce the ly cut the volume to zero.
volume. The audio display will show “MUTE”.
A number indicating the volume will be If you press the button again, the original
shown on the audio display. sound volume will return and “MUTE”
goes off.
Audio 5-41
Interior light ........................................................ 6-2 To install the cover housing .................................. 6-14
Dome light ............................................................... 6-2 To install the rear gate board ................................ 6-14
Cargo area light (Station wagon) .......................... 6-2 Stowage boxes (Station wagon) ....................... 6-15
Map light ............................................................. 6-2 Convenient tie-down hooks (if equipped) ........ 6-15
Sun visors ........................................................... 6-3 Under-floor storage compartment .................... 6-16
Sun visor extension plate ...................................... 6-3
HomeLink® Wireless Control System
Vanity mirror with light ........................................... 6-4
(if equipped) ..................................................... 6-17
Storage compartment ........................................ 6-4 Garage door opener programming in the
Glove box ................................................................ 6-4 U.S.A. ..................................................................... 6-18
Center console box ................................................ 6-5 Programming rolling-code-protected garage door
Center panel compartment (if equipped) .............. 6-6 openers in the U.S.A. ........................................... 6-19 6
Overhead console (if equipped) ............................ 6-6 Programming for entrance gates and garage door
Cup holder .......................................................... 6-7 openers in Canada ............................................... 6-20
Front passenger’s cup holder ............................... 6-7 Programming other devices .................................. 6-20
Rear passenger’s cup holder ................................ 6-7 Operating the HomeLink® Wireless Control
Accessory power outlets ................................... 6-8 System ................................................................... 6-20
Reprogramming a single HomeLink® button ...... 6-20
Ashtray ................................................................ 6-9 Erasing HomeLink® button memory .................... 6-21
Front ashtray ........................................................... 6-9 In case a problem occurs ....................................... 6-21
Coat hook ............................................................ 6-10
Rear passenger area .............................................. 6-10
Shopping bag hook ............................................ 6-11
Floor mat ............................................................. 6-12
Cargo area cover (Station wagon) .................... 6-12
Using the cover ....................................................... 6-12
To remove the cover housing ................................ 6-13
To remove the rear gate board .............................. 6-13
Stowage of the cargo area cover and rear gate
board ..................................................................... 6-13
6-2 Interior equipment
Interior light The setting of the period for which the light Map light
Interior equipment
600494
400254
600496
– CONTINUED –
6-4 Interior equipment
600499
1) Lock
2) Unlock
close it, push the lid firmly upward. To use as storage space:
To lock the glove box, insert the key and
turn it clockwise. If you hold the divider plate at the
top while turning it counterclock-
Center console box wise, it may break.
Center console box (front) To use again as cupholders:
600206
600500
600502
If you remove the divider plate from the Insert the protrusion on the back of the di-
dual cupholders, you can use the center vider plate into the hole in the center of the
console box as a storage space. console box. Grasp the divider plate at the
base, and turn it clockwise to fit it.
600503
600201
To open the center panel compartment,
Pull up the lock release knob at the bottom pull up the edge of the bottom of the panel 400233
of the front edge of the lid. lid.
To open the console, push on the lid light-
ly and it will automatically open.
Center panel compartment (if
equipped)
When your vehicle is parked in the
sun or on a warm day, the inside of
When your vehicle is parked in the the overhead console heats up.
sun or a warm day, the inside of the Avoid storing plastic or other heat-
center panel heats up. Avoid storing vulnerable or flammable articles
plastic or other heat-vulnerable or such as a lighter in the overhead
flammable articles such as a lighter console.
in the center panel.
Interior equipment 6-7
Cup holder Front passenger’s cup holder Rear passenger’s cup holder
600506
– CONTINUED –
6-10 Interior equipment
Coat hook
Rear passenger area Do not hang coat hangers or other
hard or pointed objects on the coat
hooks. If such items were hanging
on the coat hooks during deploy-
ment of the SRS curtain airbags,
they could cause serious injuries by
coming off the coat hooks and being
thrown through the cabin or by pre-
venting correct airbag deployment.
600512
Before hanging clothing on the coat
hooks, make sure there are no
To remove the ashtray for cleaning, hold pointed objects in the pockets.
the right and left sides of the ashtray and Hang clothing directly on the coat
pull it out. 600516 hooks without using hangers.
400249
600215
The coat hook is attached to each rear
passenger’s hand grip. A shopping bag hook is attached to each
side of the cargo area.
To use the hook, push the upper portion
and the shopping bag hook will appear.
400253
600513
A retaining pin is located on the driver’s Make sure the driver’s floor mat is
side of the vehicle next to the fuel filler placed back in its proper location
door release. Fit the grommet in the car- and correctly secured on its retain-
pet onto the pin to prevent the carpet from ing pin. If the floor mat slips forward
moving. and interferes with the movement of
the pedals during driving, it could
cause an accident.
400237
To remove the rear gate the rear gate board, rotate the rear gate
board board toward you, and pull it out down-
Do not place anything on the ex- 0
ward.
tended cover. Putting excessive
weight on the extended cover can Stowage of the cargo area
break it and an object on the cover cover and rear gate board
could tumble forward in the event of
The cargo area cover and rear gate board
a sudden stop or collision. This
can be stowed in under the cargo floor.
could cause serious injury.
400240
600214
400239
board in the cargo area end. To install the rear gate board
600110
(provided on the back of the lid) on the Insert (tipped at an angle) the hooks on
rear edge of the roof. 400336
the rear gate board into the holes in the
3. Remove the left and right parts of the rear gate panel.
cargo floor lid. To install the cover housing, insert both
ends of the cover housing into the retain-
ers.
600515
400235
Rotate the rear gate board toward you un-
4. Stow the cover housing and rear gate
Interior equipment 6-15
til its top touches the rear gate panel. Stowage boxes (Station wag- Convenient tie-down hooks
on) (if equipped)
600535
600115
600111
– CONTINUED –
6-18 Interior equipment
NOTE
y After programming your HomeLink®
Wireless Control System for the de- 600430 600431
sired devices, retain the hand-held
transmitters for further programming 2. Press and hold the two outside 4. Using both hands, simultaneously
or device testing in the event of a prob- HomeLink® buttons until the indicator light push the hand-held transmitter button and
lem. begins to flash (after 20 seconds). Re- the desired HomeLink® button. DO NOT
y It is recommended that you insert a lease both buttons. release the buttons until step 5 has been
new battery in the hand-held transmit- completed.
ter of a device to ensure correct pro- NOTE 5. Hold down both buttons until the
gramming. If any of the HomeLink® buttons are al- HomeLink® indicator light flashes, first
ready programmed for other devices, slowly then rapidly. When the indicator
skip step 2 because it clears the mem-
Garage door opener pro- ory of all the three buttons.
light flashes rapidly, both buttons may be
gramming in the U.S.A. released. (The rapidly flashing light indi-
3. Hold the end of the garage door open- cates successful programming of the new
NOTE er’s hand-held transmitter between 1 and frequency signal.)
When programming the HomeLink® 3 inches (25 and 76 mm) away from the 6. Press and hold the programmed button
Wireless Control System for a garage HomeLink® buttons on the driver’s sun vi- and check the HomeLink® indicator light.
door opener, it is suggested that you sor, keeping the indicator light in view. If the indicator light stays on continuously,
park the vehicle outside the garage. your garage door should activate and the
programming is completed.
1. Unplug the motor of the garage door If the indicator light flashes rapidly for two
opener from the outlet. seconds and then stays on continuously,
Interior equipment 6-19
your garage door opener may be protect- may make the programming quicker
ed by a rolling code feature. In this case and easier. 1
you need to perform the additional steps
for “Programming rolling-code-protected
garage door openers in the U.S.A.” de-
scribed in the following.
NOTE
Rolling-code-protected garage door
openers are manufactured after 1996.
See the instruction manual of your ga-
rage opener for confirmation.
600433
7. Reconnect the motor of your garage
door opener to the outlet. 1) Training button
8. Test your garage door opener by 600432
pressing the programmed HomeLink® 2. Press the training button on the garage
button. 1. Locate the training button on the ga- door opener motor head unit (which acti-
rage door opener motor head unit. The ex- vates the “training light” on the unit). Pro-
act location and color of the button may ceed to step 3 within 30 seconds.
Programming rolling-code- vary by brand of garage door opener. If it 3. Inside the vehicle, firmly press and re-
protected garage door open- is difficult to locate the training button, re- lease the HomeLink® button that was pro-
ers in the U.S.A. fer to your garage door opener’s instruc- grammed in the section above. Press and
If your garage door opener has a rolling tion manual. release the button a second time to com-
code feature, program the HomeLink® plete the programming procedure.
Wireless Control System for it by following NOTE
steps 1 through 5 in the “Programming ga- Some garage door openers may re-
rage door openers in the U.S.A.” section quire you to do the above procedure a
above and then continuing with the follow- third time to complete the program-
ing steps. ming.
NOTE 4. The garage door opener should now
The assistance of a second person recognize the HomeLink® Wireless Con-
– CONTINUED –
6-20 Interior equipment
trol System and your garage door opener ory of all three buttons. opener by pressing the programmed
should activate when the HomeLink® but- HomeLink® button.
ton is pressed. 3. Hold the end of the entrance gate’s/ga-
rage door opener’s hand-held transmitter
between 1 and 3 inches (25 and 76 mm) Programming other devices
Programming for entrance away from the HomeLink® buttons on the To program other devices such as door
gates and garage door open- driver’s sun visor, keeping the indicator locks, home lighting and security systems,
ers in Canada light in view. contact HomeLink at www.homelink.com
1. Unplug the motor of the entrance gate or call 1-800-355-3515.
or garage door opener from the outlet.
Operating the HomeLink®
Wireless Control System
Once programmed, the HomeLink® Wire-
less Control System can be used to re-
mote-control the devices to which its but-
tons are programmed. To activate a de-
vice, simply press the appropriate button.
The indicator light illuminates, indicating
that the signal is being transmitted.
600434
Fuel oline of 91 AKI or higher for a 2.5-liter underhood tune-up label, it is designed to
Starting and operating
turbo engine model. If other gasoline optimize engine and emission control sys-
(lower than 91 AKI) is used, knocking, tem performance with gasoline that meets
reduced output and poor accelerator the clean burning low-sulfur California
response will result. gasoline specifications. If you live in any
Use of a fuel which is low in quality
other state than California, your vehicle
or use of an inappropriate fuel addi- T Fuel octane rating will operate on gasoline meeting Federal
tive may cause engine damage. This octane rating is the average of the specifications. Gasoline sold outside Cali-
Research Octane and Motor Octane num- fornia is permitted to have higher sulfur
Fuel requirements bers and is commonly referred to as the levels, which may affect the performance
Anti Knock Index (AKI). of your vehicle’s catalytic converter and
T 2.5-liter non-turbo models Using a gasoline with a lower octane rat- may produce a sulfur exhaust odor or
The 2.5-liter non-turbo engine is designed ing can cause persistent and heavy smell. SUBARU recommends that you try
to operate using unleaded gasoline with knocking, which can damage the engine. a different brand of unleaded gasoline
an octane rating of 87 AKI or higher. Do not be concerned if your vehicle some- having lower sulfur to determine if the
times knocks lightly when you drive up a problem is fuel related before returning
T 2.5-liter turbo models and 3.0-liter hill or when you accelerate. See your
models your vehicle to an authorized dealer for
dealer or a qualified service technician if service. The CHECK ENGINE warning
The 2.5-liter turbo engine and 3.0-liter en- you use a fuel with the specified octane light/Malfunction indicator lamp may also
gine are designed to operate using premi- rating and your vehicle knocks heavily or turn on. If this occurs, return to your autho-
um unleaded gasoline with an octane rat- persistently. rized SUBARU dealer for diagnosis. If it is
ing of 91 AKI or higher. If premium unlead- determined that the condition is caused by
ed gasoline is not available, regular un- T Unleaded gasoline
the type of fuel used, repairs may not be
leaded gasoline with an octane rating of The neck of the fuel filler pipe is designed covered by your warranty.
87 AKI or higher may be temporarily used. to accept only an unleaded gasoline filler
For optimum engine performance and nozzle. Under no circumstances should T MMT
driveability, it is required (for 2.5-liter turbo leaded gasoline be used because it will Some gasoline contains an octane-en-
models), and recommended (for 3.0-liter damage the emission control system and hancing additive called MMT (Methylcy-
models) that you use premium grade un- may impair driveability and fuel economy. clopentadienyl Manganese Tricarbonyl). If
leaded gasoline. you use such fuels, your emission control
T California fuel
NOTE system performance may deteriorate and
If your vehicle was certified to California the CHECK ENGINE warning light/Mal-
Be sure to use premium unleaded gas- Emission Standards as indicated on the
Starting and operating 7-3
function indicator lamp may turn on. If this thyl Tertiary Butyl ether) or ethanol (ethyl der these conditions.
happens, return to your authorized or grain alcohol) may be used in your ve- y If undesirable driveability problems are
SUBARU Dealer for service. If it is deter- hicle, but should contain no more than experienced and you suspect they may be
mined that the condition is caused by the 15% MTBE or 10% ethanol for the proper fuel related, try a different brand of gaso-
type of fuel used, repairs may not be cov- operation of your SUBARU. line before seeking service at your
ered by your warranty. SUBARU dealer.
In addition, some gasoline suppliers are y Fuel system damage or driveability
T Gasoline for cleaner air now producing reformulated gasolines, problems which result from the use of im-
which are designed to reduce vehicle proper fuel are not covered under the
emissions. SUBARU approves the use of SUBARU Limited Warranty.
reformulated gasoline.
Do not let fuel spill on the exterior
surfaces of the vehicle. Fuels con- If you are not sure what the fuel contains,
taining alcohol may cause paint you should ask your service station oper-
damage, which is not covered under ators if their gasolines contain detergents
the SUBARU Limited Warranty. and oxygenates and if they have been re-
formulated to reduce vehicle emissions.
Your use of gasoline with detergent addi-
tives will help prevent deposits from form- As additional guidance, only use fuels
ing in your engine and fuel system. This suited for your vehicle as explained in the
helps keep your engine in tune and your following.
emission control system working properly, y Fuel should be unleaded and have an
and is a way of doing your part for cleaner octane rating no lower than that specified
air. If you continuously use a high quality in this manual.
fuel with the proper detergent and other y Methanol (methyl or wood alcohol) is
additives, you should never need to add sometimes mixed with unleaded gasoline.
any fuel system cleaning agents to your Methanol can be used in your vehicle
fuel tank. ONLY if it does not exceed 5% of the fuel
mixture AND if it is accompanied by suffi-
Many gasolines are now blended with ma- cient quantities of the proper cosolvents
terials called oxygenates. Use of these fu- and corrosion inhibitors required to pre-
els can also help keep the air cleaner. Ox- vent damage to the fuel system. Do not
ygenated blend fuels, such as MTBE (Me- use fuel containing methanol EXCEPT un-
– CONTINUED –
7-4 Starting and operating
700343
200255
y When opening the cap, do not re- y You will see the “ ” sign in the
2 fuel gauge. This indicates that the fuel
1 move the cap quickly. Fuel may be
under pressure and spray out of filler door (lid) is located on the right
the fuel filler neck especially in side of the vehicle.
hot weather, which may cause in- y If the fuel filler cap is not tightened
jury. until it clicks or if the tether is caught
under the cap, the CHECK ENGINE
4. Stop filling the tank after the fuel filler warning light may come on. Refer to
pump automatically clicks off. Do not add the “Warning and indicator lights” sec-
any more fuel. tion located in chapter 3.
5. Put the cap back on, turn it clockwise
until you hear a clicking noise. Be certain (Turbo model only) Promptly put fuel in
700344
not to catch the tether under the cap while the tank whenever the low fuel warning
tightening. light comes on. Engine misfires as a re-
1) Open sult of an empty tank could cause dam-
2) Close 6. Close the fuel filler lid completely.
If you spill any fuel on the painted surface, age to the engine.
3. Remove the fuel filler cap by turning it rinse it off immediately. Otherwise, the
slowly counterclockwise. painted surface could be damaged.
y Always use a genuine SUBARU State emission testing (U.S. der federal law to implement stricter vehi-
cle emission standards to reduce air pollu-
fuel filler cap. If you use the wrong only) tion from vehicles. A dynamometer is a
cap, it may not fit or have proper
venting, and your fuel tank and treadmill or roller-like testing device that
emission control system might be allows your vehicle’s wheels to turn while
damaged. the vehicle remains in one place. Depend-
Testing of an All-Wheel Drive vehi- ing on the severity of a state’s air pollution
cle must NEVER be performed on a problems, the states must adopt either a
single two-wheel dynamometer. At- “basic” or “enhanced” vehicle emission in-
tempting to do so will result in un- spection test. Normally, a portion of the
controlled vehicle movement and basic emission test consists of an emis-
may cause an accident or injuries to sion inspector inserting an analyzer probe
persons nearby. into the exhaust pipe of an idling vehicle
for a short period of time. States with more
severe air pollution problems are required
to adopt an enhanced vehicle emission
Resultant vehicle damage due to im- test. This test simulates actual driving
proper testing is not covered under conditions on a dynamometer and permits
the SUBARU Limited Warranty and more accurate measurement of tailpipe
is the responsibility of the state in- emitted pollution than the basic emission
spection program or its contractors test.
or licensees. The U.S. Environmental Protection Agen-
At state inspection time, remember to cy (EPA) and states using two-wheel dy-
tell your inspection or service station namometers in their emission testing pro-
in advance not to place your SUBARU grams have EXEMPTED SUBARU AWD
AWD vehicle on a two-wheel dyna- vehicles from the portion of the testing
mometer. Otherwise, serious transmis- program that involves a two-wheel dyna-
sion damage will result. mometer.
Some states have started using dyna- There are some states that use four-wheel
mometers in their state inspection pro- dynamometers in their testing programs.
grams in order to meet their obligation un- When properly used, that equipment will
not damage an AWD SUBARU vehicle.
Starting and operating 7-7
Under no circumstances should the rear vehicle’s computer with the “CHECK EN- Preparing to drive
wheels be jacked off the ground, nor GINE” warning light/MIL illuminated.
should the driveshaft be disconnected for y A state emission inspection may reject You should perform the following checks
state emission testing. (not pass or fail) a vehicle if the number of and adjustments every day before you
OBD system readiness monitors “Not start driving.
The EPA has issued regulations for in- Ready” is greater than one. Under this
specting the On-Board Diagnostic (OBD) condition, the vehicle operator should be 1. Check that all windows, mirrors, and
system as part of the state emissions in- instructed to drive his/her vehicle for a few lights are clean and unobstructed.
spection. The OBD system is designed to days to set the monitors and return for an 2. Check the appearance and condition of
detect engine and transmission problems emission re-inspection. the tires. Also check tires for proper infla-
that might cause vehicle emissions to ex- y Owners of rejected or failing vehicles tion.
ceed allowable limits. These inspections should contact their SUBARU Dealer for 3. Look under the vehicle for any sign of
apply to all 1996 model year and newer service. leaks.
passenger cars and light trucks. Over 30 4. Check that the hood, trunk (Sedan)
states plus the District of Columbia have and rear gate (Station wagon) are fully
implemented the OBD system inspection. closed.
y The inspection of the OBD system con- 5. Check the adjustment of the seat.
sists of a visual operational check of the 6. Check the adjustment of the inside and
“CHECK ENGINE” warning light/malfunc- outside mirrors.
tion indicator lamp (MIL) and an examina- 7. Fasten your seatbelt. Check that your
tion of the OBD system with an electronic passengers have fastened their seatbelts.
scan tool while the engine is running. 8. Check the operation of the warning and
y A vehicle passes the OBD system in- indicator lights when the ignition switch is
spection if proper the “CHECK ENGINE” turned to the “ON” position.
warning light/MIL illumination is observed, 9. Check the gauges, indicator and warn-
there is no stored diagnostic trouble ing lights after starting the engine.
codes, and the OBD system readiness NOTE
monitors are complete.
Engine oil, engine coolant, brake fluid,
y A vehicle fails the OBD inspection if the
washer fluid and other fluid levels
“CHECK ENGINE” warning light/MIL is
should be checked daily, weekly or at
not properly operating or there is one or
fuel stops.
more diagnostic trouble codes stored in
7-8 Starting and operating
Starting the engine If the engine does not start, try the follow- Automatic transmission vehi-
ing. cle
1) Turn the ignition switch to the “OFF”
position and wait for at least 10 sec-
onds. After checking that the parking
Do not operate the starter motor
brake is firmly set, turn the ignition If you restart the engine while the
continuously for more than ten sec-
switch to the “START” position while de- vehicle is moving, shift the selector
onds. If the engine fails to start after
pressing the accelerator pedal slightly lever into the “N” position. Do not
operating the starter for five to ten
(approximately a quarter of the full attempt to place the selector lever of
seconds, wait for ten seconds or
stroke). Release the accelerator pedal a moving vehicle into the “P” posi-
more before trying again.
as soon as the engine starts. tion.
2) If this fails to start the engine, turn the
Manual transmission vehicle ignition switch back to the “OFF” posi- 1. Apply the parking brake.
1. Apply the parking brake. tion and wait for at least 10 seconds. 2. Turn off unnecessary lights and acces-
2. Turn off unnecessary lights and acces- Then fully depress the accelerator ped- sories.
sories. al and turn the ignition switch to the 3. Shift the selector lever to the “P” or “N”
3. Press the clutch pedal to the floor and “START” position. If the engine starts, position (preferably “P” position). The
shift the shift lever into neutral. quickly release the accelerator pedal. starter will only operate when the select
Hold the clutch pedal to the floor while 3) If this fails to start the engine, turn the lever is at the “P” or “N” position.
starting the engine. The starter motor will ignition switch again to the “OFF” posi- 4. Turn the ignition switch to the “ON” po-
only operate when the clutch pedal is tion. After waiting for 10 seconds or sition and check the operation of the warn-
pressed fully to the floor. longer, turn the ignition switch to the ing and indicator lights. Refer to the
4. Turn the ignition switch to the “ON” po- “START” position without depressing “Warning and indicator lights” section
sition and check the operation of the warn- the accelerator pedal. (chapter 3).
ing and indicator lights. Refer to the 4) If the engine still refuses to start, con- 5. Turn the ignition switch to the “START”
“Warning and indicator lights” section tact your nearest SUBARU dealer for position without depressing the accelera-
(chapter 3). assistance. tor pedal. Release the key immediately af-
5. Turn the ignition switch to the “START” 6. Confirm that all warning and indicator ter the engine has started.
position without depressing the accelera- lights have gone off after the engine has If the engine does not start, try the follow-
tor pedal. Release the key immediately af- started. The fuel injection system auto- ing.
ter the engine has started. matically lowers the idle speed as the en- 1) Turn the ignition switch to the “OFF”
gine warms up. position and wait for at least 10 sec-
Starting and operating 7-9
onds. After checking that the parking Stopping the engine Manual transmission
brake is firmly set, turn the ignition
switch to the “START” position while de-
pressing the accelerator pedal slightly
(approximately a quarter of the full
Do not stop the engine when the ve- Do not drive the vehicle with the
stroke). Release the accelerator pedal
hicle is moving. This will cause loss clutch disengaged (i.e., when the
as soon as the engine starts.
of power to the power steering and clutch pedal is depressed) or with
2) If this fails to start the engine, turn the
the brake booster, making steering the shift lever in the neutral posi-
ignition switch back to the “OFF” posi-
and braking more difficult. It could tion. Engine braking has no effect in
tion and wait for at least 10 seconds.
also result in accidental activation either of these conditions and the
Then fully depress the accelerator ped-
of the “LOCK” position on the igni- risk of an accident is consequently
al and turn the ignition switch to the
tion switch, causing the steering increased.
“START” position. If the engine starts,
wheel to lock.
quickly release the accelerator pedal.
3) If this fails to start the engine, turn the The ignition switch should be turned off
ignition switch again to the “OFF” posi- only when the vehicle is stopped and the Shift into reverse ONLY when the
tion. After waiting for 10 seconds or engine is idling. vehicle has completely stopped. It
longer, turn the ignition switch to the
may cause damage to the transmis-
“START” position without depressing
sion to try shifting into reverse
the accelerator pedal.
when the vehicle is moving.
4) If the engine still refuses to start, con-
tact your nearest SUBARU dealer for The manual transmission is a fully syn-
assistance. chromeshed, 5-forward-speed and 1-re-
6. Confirm that all warning and indicator verse-speed transmission.
lights have gone out after the engine has
started. The fuel injection system auto-
matically lowers the idle speed as the en-
gine warms up.
While the engine is warming up, make
sure that the selector lever is at the “P” or
“N” position and that the parking brake is
applied.
– CONTINUED –
7-10 Starting and operating
speeds listed in the following table. speeds that are possible with each differ-
ent gear.
Shift up mph (km/h)
Never exceed the speed limit below for
1st to 2nd 15 (24) each gear position except for brief accel-
eration in an emergency. The tachome-
2nd to 3rd 25 (40) ter’s needle (if so equipped) will enter the
red area if these speeds are exceeded.
3rd to 4th 40 (65)
Failure to observe this precaution can
4th to 5th 45 (73) lead to excessive engine wear and poor
fuel economy.
T Maximum allowable speeds Non-turbo models
700101 mph (km/h)
The shift pattern is shown on the shift le- Gear Except OUTBACK
ver knob. When shifting from 5th gear to OUTBACK
When shifting down a gear, ensure
reverse gear, first return the shift lever to 1st 30 (48) 30 (48)
that the vehicle is not travelling at a
the neutral position then shift into reverse
speed exceeding the Maximum Al-
gear. 2nd 50 (81) 52 (82)
lowable Speed for the gear which is
To change gears, fully depress the clutch about to be selected. Failure to ob- 3rd 71 (116) 71 (116)
pedal, move the shift lever, and gradually serve this precaution can lead to en-
let up on the clutch pedal. gine over-revving and this in turn
can result in engine damage. Turbo models
If it is difficult to shift into gear, put the mph (km/h)
transmission in neutral, release the clutch In addition, sudden application of
pedal momentarily, and then try again. Gear Except OUTBACK
engine brakes when the vehicle is
OUTBACK
travelling on a slippery surface can
Shifting speeds lead to wheel locking; as a conse- 1st 32 (52) 32 (52)
quence, control of the vehicle may
T Recommended shifting speeds be lost and the risk of an accident in- 2nd 54 (88) 54 (88)
The best compromise between fuel econ- creased.
omy and vehicle performance during nor- 3rd 80 (129) 78 (127)
mal driving is ensured by shifting up at the The following table shows the maximum
Starting and operating 7-11
Never exceed posted speed limits. occur in the models with a 2.5-liter turbo Automatic transmission – 4-
engine before the engine warms up.
speed
Driving tips
Do not drive with your foot resting on the The automatic transmission is electroni-
clutch pedal and do not use the clutch to cally controlled and provides 4 forward
hold your vehicle at a standstill on an up- speeds and 1 reverse speed. Also, it has
grade. Either of those actions may cause a manual mode and a SPORT mode.
clutch damage.
Do not drive with your hand resting on the
shift lever. This may cause wear on the
transmission components. Do not shift from the “P” or “N” po-
sition into the “D” or “R” position
When it is necessary to reduce vehicle while depressing the accelerator
speed due to slow traffic, turning corners, pedal. This may cause the vehicle to
or driving up steep hills, downshift to a jump forward or backward.
lower gear before the engine starts to la-
bor.
y On steep downgrades, downshift the
transmission to 4th, 3rd or 2nd gear as y Shift into the “P” or “R” position
necessary; this helps to maintain a safe only after the vehicle is complete-
speed and to extend brake pad life. ly stopped. Shifting while the ve-
In this way, the engine provides a braking hicle is moving may cause dam-
effect. Remember, if you “ride” (over use) age to the transmission.
the brakes while descending a hill, they y Do not race the engine for more
may overheat and not work properly. than five seconds in any position
y The engine may, on rare occasions, except the “N” or “P” position
knock when the vehicle rapidly acceler- when the brake is set or when
ates or rapidly pulls away from a standstill. chocks are used in the wheels.
This phenomenon does not indicate a This may cause the automatic
fault. transmission fluid to overheat.
y A slight reduction in output torque may
– CONTINUED –
7-12 Starting and operating
y Avoid shifting from one of the for- the transmission to shift at the most In this position, the transmission is me-
ward driving positions into the appropriate times for the current con- chanically locked to prevent the vehicle
“R” position or vice versa until the dition of your vehicle. Optimized shift- from rolling freely.
vehicle has completely stopped. ing will be restored as the vehicle con-
tinues to be driven for a while. When you park the vehicle, first set the
Such shifting may cause damage parking brake fully, then shift into the “P”
to the transmission. position. Do not hold the vehicle with only
y When parking the vehicle, first se- Selector lever the transmission.
curely apply the parking brake
To shift the selector lever from the “P” to
and then place the selector lever
any other position, you should depress the
in the “P” position. Avoid parking
for a long time with the selector le- brake pedal fully then move the selector
ver in any other position as doing lever. This prevents the vehicle from
so could result in a dead battery. lurching when it is started.
T R (Reverse)
NOTE This position is for backing the vehicle.
y When the engine coolant tempera-
ture is still low, your vehicle’s automat- To shift from the “N” to “R” position, stop
ic transmission will up-shift at higher the vehicle completely then move the le-
engine speeds than when the coolant ver to the “R” position.
700107
temperature is sufficiently high in or-
der to shorten the warm-up time and T N (Neutral)
: Shift possible with brake pedal de-
improve driveability. The gearshift tim- pressed
This position is for restarting a stalled en-
ing will automatically shift to the nor- : Shift possible with brake pedal not gine.
mal timing after the engine has warmed depressed In this position the wheels and transmis-
up. sion are not locked. In this position, the
y Immediately after ATF (automatic The selector lever has four positions, “P”, transmission is neutral; the vehicle will roll
transmission fluid) is replaced, you “R”, “N”, “D” and also has manual gate for freely, even on the slightest incline unless
may feel that the automatic transmis- using “SPORT” mode or manual mode. the parking brake or foot brake is on.
sion operation is somewhat unusual. Avoid coasting with the transmission neu-
T P (Park)
This results from invalidation of data tral.
which the on-board computer has col- This position is for parking the vehicle and During coasting, there is no engine brak-
lected and stored in memory to allow starting the engine. ing effect.
Starting and operating 7-13
NOTE ver from this position into the manual gate. NOTE
If the selector lever is in the “N” posi- To use the manual mode, move the lever y A 4th-to-3rd automatic downshift will
tion when you stop the engine for park- from this position into the manual gate not occur at speeds above 50 mph (80
ing, you may not subsequently be able then move it toward the “+” and “–” ends. km/h) and a 3rd-to-2nd automatic
to move it to the “R” and “P” positions. V While climbing a grade downshift will not occur at speeds
If this happens, turn the ignition switch above 24 mph (38 km/h).
When driving up a hill, undesired upshift to
to the “ON” position. You will then be y Automatic downshifts to 3rd or 2nd
4th gear is prevented from taking place
able to move the selector lever to the may occur even when driving on a level
“P” position. when the accelerator is released. This road depending on conditions, such as
minimizes the chance of subsequent
how hard you depress the brake pedal.
downshifting to a lower gear when accel-
erating again. This prevents repeated up-
shifting and downshifting resulting in a Selector lever reverse inhibit-
Do not drive the vehicle with the se-
lector lever in the “N” (neutral) posi- smoother operation of the vehicle. ing function
tion. Engine braking has no effect in NOTE This function prevents accidental move-
this condition and the risk of an ac- The transmission may downshift to ment of the selector lever to the “R” posi-
cident is consequently increased. 2nd or 1st gear, depending on the way tion while the vehicle is moving.
the accelerator pedal is pressed to ac- The function becomes operational when
T D (Drive) the vehicle reaches a speed of approxi-
celerate the vehicle again.
This position is for normal driving. mately 6 mph (10 km/h). Once operation-
The transmission automatically shifts into V While going down a hill al, it prevents the selector lever from being
a suitable gear from 1st to 4th according to When you are descending a hill or any moved from the “N” position to the “R” po-
the vehicle speed and the acceleration other slope while braking with the sition. When the vehicle speed drops be-
you require. “SPORT” mode selected, the transmis- low 6 mph (10 km/h), the function is can-
sion may downshift to 3rd or 2nd gear de- celed. The selector lever can then be
When more acceleration is required in this moved to the “R” and “P” positions.
position, press the accelerator pedal fully pending on how hard you depress the
to the floor and hold that position. The brake pedal, causing engine braking to When the ignition switch has been turned
transmission will automatically downshift work. Reacceleration for a short time will to the “OFF” position, movement of the se-
to 3rd, 2nd or 1st gear. When you release cause the transmission to upshift normal- lector lever from the “N” position to the “R”
the pedal, the transmission will return to ly. position is possible for a limited time peri-
the original gear position. od and then becomes impossible. Also,
To use the “SPORT” mode, move the le- the selector lever cannot be moved to the
– CONTINUED –
7-14 Starting and operating
“R” position when it has been placed in the screwdriver inserted into the hole, move
“P” position and then placed again in the the selector lever to the “P” position. If the
“N” position. When movement of the se- selector lever reverse inhibiting function
lector lever from the “N” position to the “R” fails, have the vehicle inspected by the 1
position has become impossible, turn the nearest SUBARU dealer.
ignition switch back to the “ON” position
then move the selector lever to the “P” po- Selection of manual mode
sition. Pressing the selector lever release
button also makes it possible to move the
selector lever to the “P” position at this 2 3
time.
T Selector lever release button 700308
1) Upshift indicator
2) Downshift indicator
3) Gear position indicator
Gearshifts can be performed using the se- the engine speed reaches a predeter- Maximum speeds
lector lever. mined level, a fuel-cut function will op-
erate. Shift up if this happens.
y If you attempt to shift down when the
engine speed is too high, i.e., when a When down shifting, ensure that the
downshift would push the tachometer vehicle is not travelling at a speed
needle beyond the red zone, beeps will exceeding the Maximum Allowable
be emitted to warn you that the down- Speed for the gear which is about to
shift is not possible. be selected. Failure to observe this
y If you attempt to shift up when the precaution can lead to engine over-
vehicle speed is too low, the transmis- revving and this in turn can result in
sion will not respond. engine damage.
y You can perform a skip-shift (for ex-
In addition, sudden application of
ample, from 4th to 2nd) by operating
700111 engine braking caused by down
the selector lever twice in rapid suc-
shifting when the vehicle is travel-
Using the selector lever cession.
ling on a slippery surface can lead to
Shift to the next-higher gear by briefly y The transmission automatically se-
wheel locking; as a consequence,
pushing the selector lever toward the “+” lects 1st gear when the vehicle stops
control of the vehicle may be lost
end of the manual gate. moving.
and the risk of an accident in-
Shift to the next-lower gear by briefly pull- y If the temperature of the automatic
creased.
ing the selector lever toward the “–” end of transmission fluid becomes too high,
the manual gate. the “AT OIL TEMP” warning light will The following tables show the maximum
come on and upshifts to 4th gear will speeds that are possible with each differ-
NOTE not be possible. Immediately stop the ent gear.
Please read the following points care- vehicle in a safe place and let the en-
fully and bear them in mind when using gine idle until the warning light goes When down shifting, it is important to con-
the manual mode. off. firm that the current vehicle speed is not in
y The transmission does not automati- excess of the Maximum Allowable Speed
cally shift up in the manual mode. Per- of the gear which is about to be selected.
form gearshifts in accordance with
road conditions so that the tachometer
needle does not enter the red zone. If
– CONTINUED –
7-16 Starting and operating
1 34 (55)
2 64 (103)
3 99 (160)
– CONTINUED –
7-18 Starting and operating
y Avoid shifting from one of the for- the transmission to shift at the most In this position, the transmission is me-
ward driving positions into the appropriate times for the current con- chanically locked to prevent the vehicle
“R” position or vice versa until the dition of your vehicle. Optimized shift- from rolling freely.
vehicle has completely stopped. ing will be restored as the vehicle con-
tinues to be driven for a while. When you park the vehicle, first set the
Such shifting may cause damage parking brake fully, then shift into the “P”
to the transmission. position. Do not hold the vehicle with only
y When parking the vehicle, first se- Selector lever the transmission.
curely apply the parking brake
and then place the selector lever To shift the selector lever from the “P” to
in the “P” position. Avoid parking any other position, you should depress the
for a long time with the selector le- brake pedal fully then move the selector
ver in any other position as doing lever. This prevents the vehicle from
so could result in a dead battery. lurching when it is started.
NOTE (3.0-liter models only)
NOTE To protect the engine while the “P” po-
y When the engine coolant tempera- sition is selected, the engine is con-
ture is still low, your vehicle’s automat- trolled such that the engine speed
ic transmission will up-shift at higher does not become too high even if the
engine speeds than when the coolant accelerator pedal is pressed hard.
700107
temperature is sufficiently high in or-
der to shorten the warm-up time and T R (Reverse)
: Shift possible with brake pedal de-
improve driveability. The gearshift tim- pressed This position is for backing the vehicle.
ing will automatically shift to the nor- : Shift possible with brake pedal not
mal timing after the engine has warmed depressed To shift from the “N” to “R” position, stop
up. the vehicle completely then move the le-
y Immediately after ATF (automatic The selector lever has four positions, “P”, ver to the “R” position.
transmission fluid) is replaced, you “R”, “N”, “D” and also has manual gate for
T N (Neutral)
may feel that the automatic transmis- using “SPORT” mode or manual mode.
This position is for restarting a stalled en-
sion operation is somewhat unusual. T P (Park) gine.
This results from invalidation of data
This position is for parking the vehicle and In this position the wheels and transmis-
which the on-board computer has col-
starting the engine. sion are not locked. In this position, the
lected and stored in memory to allow
Starting and operating 7-19
transmission is neutral; the vehicle will roll T D (Drive) the accelerator pedal is pressed to ac-
freely, even on the slightest incline unless This position is for normal driving. celerate the vehicle again.
the parking brake or foot brake is on. The transmission automatically shifts into
Avoid coasting with the transmission neu- V While going down a hill
a suitable gear from 1st to 5th according to
tral. the vehicle speed and the acceleration When you are descending a hill or any
During coasting, there is no engine brak- you require. other slope while braking with the
ing effect. “SPORT” mode selected, the transmis-
When more acceleration is required in this sion may downshift to 4th or 3rd gear de-
NOTE (3.0-liter models only) position, press the accelerator pedal fully pending on how hard you depress the
To protect the engine while the “N” po- to the floor and hold that position. The brake pedal, causing engine braking to
sition is selected, the engine is con- transmission will automatically downshift work. Reacceleration for a short time will
trolled such that the engine speed to 4th, 3rd, 2nd or 1st gear. When you re- cause the transmission to upshift normal-
does not become too high even if the lease the pedal, the transmission will re- ly.
accelerator pedal is pressed hard. turn to the original gear position.
To use the SPORT mode, move the lever NOTE
NOTE from this position into the manual gate. y A 5th-to-4th automatic downshift will
If the selector lever is in the “N” posi- To use the manual mode, move the lever not occur at speeds above 78 mph (126
tion when you stop the engine for park- from this position into the manual gate km/h) and a 4th-to-3rd automatic down-
ing, you may not subsequently be able then move it toward the “+” and “–” ends. shift will not occur at speeds above 53
to move it to the “R” and “P” positions. mph (86 km/h).
If this happens, turn the ignition switch V While climbing a grade y Automatic downshifts to 4th or 3rd
to the “ON” position. You will then be When driving up a hill, undesired upshift to may occur even when driving on a level
able to move the selector lever to the 4th or 5th gear is prevented from taking road depending on conditions, such as
“P” position. place when the accelerator is released. how hard you depress the brake pedal.
This minimizes the chance of subsequent
downshifting to a lower gear when accel- Selector lever reverse inhibit-
erating again. This prevents repeated up- ing function
Do not drive the vehicle with the se- shifting and downshifting resulting in a
lector lever in the “N” (neutral) posi- smoother operation of the vehicle. This function prevents accidental move-
tion. Engine braking has no effect in ment of the selector lever to the “R” posi-
this condition and the risk of an ac- NOTE tion while the vehicle is moving.
cident is consequently increased. The transmission may downshift to The function becomes operational when
2nd or 1st gear, depending on the way the vehicle reaches a speed of approxi-
– CONTINUED –
7-20 Starting and operating
mately 6 mph (10 km/h). Once operation- T Selector lever release button Selection of manual mode
al, it prevents the selector lever from being
moved from the “N” position to the “R” po-
sition. When the vehicle speed drops be-
low 6 mph (10 km/h), the function is can-
celed. The selector lever can then be
moved to the “R” and “P” positions.
When the ignition switch has been turned
to the “OFF” position, movement of the se-
lector lever from the “N” position to the “R”
position is possible for a limited time peri-
od and then becomes impossible. Also,
the selector lever cannot be moved to the 700345 700109
“R” position when it has been placed in the
“P” position and then placed again in the If you inadvertently have turned the igni- With the vehicle either moving or station-
“N” position. When movement of the se- tion switch to the “OFF” position with the ary, move the selector lever from the “D”
lector lever from the “N” position to the “R” selector lever in the “N” position, proceed position to the manual gate then move it to
position has become impossible, turn the as follows. By referring to the “Shift lock the “+” end or “–” end of the manual gate
ignition switch back to the “ON” position release” section in this chapter, remove to select manual mode.
then move the selector lever to the “P” po- the shift lock release cover. Then, with the
sition. Pressing the selector lever release screwdriver inserted into the hole, move
button also makes it possible to move the the selector lever to the “P” position. If the
selector lever to the “P” position at this selector lever reverse inhibiting function
time. fails, have the vehicle inspected by the
nearest SUBARU dealer.
Starting and operating 7-21
2 3
700308 300106
– CONTINUED –
7-22 Starting and operating
transmission will automatically switch engine speed is too high, i.e., when a Maximum speeds
back from manual mode to normal mode. downshift would push the tachometer
needle beyond the red zone, beeps will
NOTE be emitted to warn you that the down-
Please read the following points care- shift is not possible. When down shifting, ensure that the
fully and bear them in mind when using y If you attempt to shift up when the vehicle is not travelling at a speed
the manual mode. vehicle speed is too low, the transmis- exceeding the Maximum Allowable
y When the temperature of the auto- sion will not respond. Speed for the gear which is about to
matic transmission fluid is higher than y You can perform a skip-shift (for ex- be selected. Failure to observe this
normal, warning beeps are emitted and ample, from 4th to 2nd) by operating precaution can lead to engine over-
the shift position indicator shows “–”. the selector lever or a steering-wheel revving and this in turn can result in
If these warnings are issued, deselect switch twice in rapid succession. engine damage.
the manual mode to protect the auto- y The transmission automatically se-
matic transmission from damage. In addition, sudden application of
lects 1st gear when the vehicle stops
y When the temperature of the engine engine braking caused by down
moving.
oil is higher than normal, warning shifting when the vehicle is travel-
y If the temperature of the automatic
beeps are emitted and the shift posi- ling on a slippery surface can lead to
transmission fluid becomes too high,
tion indicator shows “–”. If these warn- wheel locking; as a consequence,
the “AT OIL TEMP” warning light will
ings are issued, deselect the manual control of the vehicle may be lost
come on and upshifts to 5th gear will
mode to protect the engine from dam- and the risk of an accident in-
not be possible. Immediately stop the
age. (3.0-liter models only) creased.
vehicle in a safe place and let the en-
y The transmission does not automati- gine idle until the warning light goes The following tables show the maximum
cally shift up in the manual mode. Per- off. speeds that are possible with each differ-
form gearshifts in accordance with
ent gear.
road conditions so that the tachometer
needle does not enter the red zone. If When down shifting, it is important to con-
the engine speed reaches a predeter- firm that the current vehicle speed is not in
mined level, a fuel-cut function will op- excess of the Maximum Allowable Speed
erate. Shift up if this happens. (Also, in of the gear which is about to be selected.
the case of a 3.0-liter model, the trans-
mission may automatically shift up to
protect the engine.)
y If you attempt to shift down when the
Starting and operating 7-23
y On a road surface where there is a risk When selected, the SPORT mode indica-
of wheelspin (for example, a snow- or tor light on the instrument panel will turn
gravel-covered road), you can pull away on.
from a standstill safely and easily by first To deselect SPORT mode, move the se-
selecting the 2nd gear of the manual lector lever to the “D” position or select
mode. manual mode. To subsequently reselect
y Always apply the foot or parking brake 700112 SPORT mode, move the selector lever to
when the vehicle is stopped in the “D” or the “D” position and from there to the man-
“R” position. SPORT mode is used when power is ual gate.
y Always set the parking brake when needed for rapid acceleration or for uphill In this mode, the transmission shifts up at
parking your vehicle. Do not hold the vehi- driving. To select this mode, move the se- higher vehicle speeds and shifts down
cle with only the transmission. lector lever from the “D” position to the more responsively than in normal mode.
y Do not keep the vehicle in a stationary manual gate.
position on an uphill grade by using the Shift lock release
“D” position. Use the brake instead.
y The engine may, on rare occasions, If the selector lever does not move from
knock when the vehicle rapidly acceler- the “P” position with the brake pedal de-
ates or rapidly pulls away from a standstill. pressed and the ignition switch in the “ON”
This phenomenon does not indicate a position, perform the following steps:
– CONTINUED –
7-24 Starting and operating
– CONTINUED –
7-26 Starting and operating
Disc brake pad wear warning ABS (Anti-lock Brake Sys- y When you feel the ABS system
indicators tem) operating, you should maintain
constant brake pedal pressure.
Do not pump the brake pedal
since doing so may defeat the op-
eration of the ABS system.
Always use the utmost care in driv-
ing – overconfidence because you The ABS system prevents the lock-up of
are driving with an ABS equipped wheels which may occur during sudden
vehicle could easily lead to a seri- braking or braking on slippery road surfac-
ous accident. es. This helps prevent the loss of steering
control and directional stability caused by
wheel lock-up.
y The ABS system does not always When the ABS system is operating, you
700040
decrease stopping distance. You may hear a chattering noise or feel a slight
The disc brake pad wear warning indica- should always maintain a safe fol- vibration in the brake pedal. This is normal
tors on the disc brakes give a warning lowing distance from other vehi- when the ABS operates.
noise when the brake pads are worn. cles. The ABS system will not operate when the
If a squeaking or scraping noise is heard y When driving on badly surfaced vehicle speed is below approximately 6
from the disc brakes while braking, imme- roads, gravel roads, icy road, or mph (10 km/h).
diately have your vehicle inspected by the over deep newly fallen snow,
nearest SUBARU dealer. stopping distances may be longer ABS system self-check
for a vehicle with the ABS system
than one without. When driving You may feel a slight shock in the brake
under these conditions, therefore, pedal and hear the operating sound of
reduce your speed and leave am- ABS from the engine compartment just af-
ple distance from other vehicles. ter the vehicle is started. This is caused by
an automatic functional test of the ABS
system being carried out and does not in-
dicate any abnormal condition.
Starting and operating 7-27
ABS warning light y The warning light does not come voltage such as when the engine is jump
on when the ignition switch is started, the ABS warning light may come
turned to the “ON” position. on. This is due to the low battery voltage
and does not indicate a malfunction.
y The warning light comes on when When the battery becomes fully charged,
the ignition switch is turned to the the light will go out.
“ON” position, but it does not go
out even when the vehicle speed
exceeds approximately 8 mph (12
km/h).
y The warning light comes on dur-
ing driving.
If these occur, have the ABS system
700348
repaired at the first available oppor-
The ABS warning light comes on when the tunity by your SUBARU dealer.
ignition switch is turned to the “ON” posi-
tion and goes out after approximately two
NOTE
If the warning light behavior is as de-
seconds.
scribed in the following, the ABS sys-
This is an indication that the ABS system
tem may be considered normal.
is working properly.
y The warning light comes on right af-
ter the engine is started but goes out
immediately, remaining off.
If the warning light behaves as fol- y The warning light remains on after
lows, the ABS system may not be the engine has been started, but it goes
working properly. out when the vehicle speed reaches
approximately 8 mph (12 km/h).
When the warning light is on, the y The warning light comes on during
ABS function shuts down; however, driving, but it goes out immediately
the conventional brake system con- and remains off.
tinues to operate normally.
When driving with an insufficient battery
7-28 Starting and operating
Electronic Brake Force Dis- Steps to take if EBD system warning light illuminate simultaneously,
fails take the following steps:
tribution (EBD) system 1. Stop the vehicle in the nearest safe, flat
place.
The EBD system maximizes the effective-
2. Shut down the engine, then restart it.
ness of the brakes by allowing the rear
3. Release the parking brake. If both
brakes to supply a greater proportion of
warning lights go out, the EBD system
the braking force. It functions by adjusting
may be faulty.
the distribution of braking force to the rear
Drive carefully to the nearest SUBARU
wheels in accordance with the vehicle’s
dealer and have the system inspected.
loading condition and speed.
4. If both warning lights come on again
The EBD system is an integral part of the
and stay illuminated after the engine has
ABS system and uses some of the ABS
been restarted, shut down the engine
system’s components to perform its func-
again, apply the parking brake, and check
tion of optimizing the distribution of brak-
700349 the brake fluid level.
ing force. If any of the ABS components
5. If the brake fluid level is not below the
used by the EBD function fails, the EBD If a malfunction occurs in the EBD system, “MIN” mark, the EBD system may be
system also stops working. the system stops working and the brake faulty. Drive carefully to the nearest
When the EBD system is operating, you system warning light and ABS warning SUBARU dealer and have the system in-
may hear a chattering noise or feel a slight light come on simultaneously. spected.
vibration in the brake pedal. This is normal 6. If the brake fluid level is below the
The EBD system may be faulty if the brake
and does not indicate a malfunction. “MIN” mark, DO NOT drive the vehicle. In-
system warning light and ABS warning
stead, have the vehicle towed to the near-
light illuminate simultaneously during driv-
est SUBARU dealer for repair.
ing.
Even if the EBD system fails, the conven-
tional braking system will still function.
However, the rear wheels will be more
prone to locking when the brakes are ap-
plied harder than usual and the vehicle’s
motion may therefore become somewhat
harder to control.
If the brake system warning light and ABS
Starting and operating 7-29
– CONTINUED –
7-30 Starting and operating
– Keep the tire pressure at the may be felt when the Vehicle Dynamics snow tires or winter tires
proper level as shown on the Control system operates; a small de- y Activation of the Vehicle Dynamics
vehicle placard attached to the gree of vehicle or steering wheel shak- Control system will cause operation of
driver’s side door pillar. ing may also be noticed in this situa- the steering wheel to feel slightly dif-
tion. These are normal characteristics ferent compared to that for normal con-
In the event of wheelspin and/or skidding of Vehicle Dynamics Control operation ditions.
on a slippery road surface and/or during and are no cause for alarm. y Even if the vehicle is equipped with a
cornering and/or an evasive maneuver, y When driving off immediately after Vehicle Dynamics Control system, it is
the Vehicle Dynamics Control system ad- starting the engine, a short-lived oper- important that winter tires be used
justs the engine’s output and the wheels’ ation noise may be noticed coming when driving on snow-covered or icy
respective braking forces to help maintain from the engine compartment. This roads. (All four wheels should be fitted
traction and directional control. noise is generated as a result of a with tires of the same size and brand).
check being performed on the Vehicle Furthermore, if snow chains are to be
y Traction Control Function
Dynamics Control system and is nor- used, they should be fitted on the front
The traction control function is designed to
mal. wheels. When a vehicle is fitted with
prevent spinning of the driving wheels on
y Depending on the timing of activa- snow chains, however, the effective-
slippery road surfaces, thereby helping to
tion of the brakes, certain situations ness of the Vehicle Dynamics Control
maintain traction and directional control.
may occur just after driving off where system is reduced and this should be
Activation of this function is shown by
the brake pedal seems to exhibit a jolt- taken into account when driving the ve-
steady illumination of the Vehicle Dynam-
ing motion. This too is a consequence hicle in such a condition.
ics Control operation indicator light. y It is always important to reduce
of the Vehicle Dynamics Control opera-
y Skid Suppression Function tional check and is normal. speed when approaching a corner,
The skid suppression function is designed y In the circumstances listed in the fol- even if the vehicle is equipped with Ve-
to help maintain directional stability by lowing, the vehicle may be more unsta- hicle Dynamics Control.
suppressing the wheels’ tendency to slide ble than it feels to the driver. The Vehi- y All four wheels should be fitted with
sideways during steering operations. Acti- cle Dynamics Control System may tires of the same size, type, and brand;
vation of this function is shown by flashing therefore operate. Such operation does furthermore, the amount of wear
of the Vehicle Dynamics Control operation not indicate a system fault. should be the same for all four tires. If
indicator light. y on gravel-covered or rutted roads these precautions are not observed
y on unfinished roads and non-matching tires are used, it is
NOTE y when the vehicle is towing a trailer quite possible that the Vehicle Dynam-
y Slight twitching of the brake pedal y when the vehicle is fitted with ics Control system will be unable to op-
Starting and operating 7-31
erate correctly as intended. The following two situations could indicate ing that the Vehicle Dynamics Control sys-
y Always turn off the engine before re- a malfunction of the Vehicle Dynamics tem is not operating. It comes on in the
placing a tire as failure to do so may Control system; if either should occur, event of a malfunction in the system and is
render the Vehicle Dynamics Control have an authorized SUBARU dealer carry illuminated whenever the system is not
system unable to operate correctly. out an inspection of that system at the first operating.
available opportunity.
y The indicator light does not turn on V Vehicle Dynamics Control warning
Vehicle Dynamics Control The warning light comes on when the igni-
when the ignition switch is turned to the
system monitor ON position. tion switch is turned to the “ON” position
T Vehicle Dynamics Control operation y The indicator light does not turn off ap- and goes off several seconds after engine
indicator light proximately two seconds after the ignition startup. This lighting pattern indicates that
switch has been turned to the ON position. the Vehicle Dynamics Control system is
operating normally.
T Vehicle Dynamics Control warning
light/Vehicle Dynamics Control OFF The following situations could indicate a
indicator light malfunction of the Vehicle Dynamics Con-
trol system; if any should occur, have an
authorized SUBARU dealer carry out an
inspection of the system at the first avail-
able opportunity.
y The warning light does not turn on when
the ignition switch is turned to the ON po-
sition.
y The warning light turns on while the ve-
700350
hicle is being driven.
The indicator light turns on when the igni- y When a malfunction has occurred in the
tion switch is turned to the ON position; it Vehicle Dynamics Control electrical sys-
turns off approximately two seconds later. tem, only the warning light will turn on. In
This indicator light flashes during activa- 700351 such an event, the ABS will still be operat-
tion of the skid suppression function and is ing normally.
This single light has the function of indicat- y The warning light will also turn on when
illuminated steadily during activation of ing malfunctions in the Vehicle Dynamics
the traction control function. a problem occurs with the ABS or Vehicle
Control system and the function of indicat- Dynamics Control electronic control sys-
– CONTINUED –
7-32 Starting and operating
The Vehicle Dynamics Control system will tivate the Vehicle Dynamics Control Tire pressure monitoring
be deactivated and the vehicle will behave system, the vehicle’s running perfor-
like a model not equipped with the Vehicle mance is comparable with that of a ve-
system (TPMS) (if equipped)
Dynamics Control system. When the hicle that does not have a Vehicle Dy-
switch is pressed again to reactivate the namics Control system. Do not deacti-
Vehicle Dynamics Control system, the in- vate the Vehicle Dynamics Control sys-
dicator light goes off. tem except when absolutely neces-
With the Vehicle Dynamics Control sys- sary.
tem deactivated, traction and stability en-
hancement offered by Vehicle Dynamics
Control system is unavailable. Therefore
you should not deactivate the Vehicle Dy-
namics Control system except under
above-mentioned situations.
NOTE 700352
y When the switch has been pressed
to deactivate the Vehicle Dynamics The tire pressure monitoring system pro-
Control system, the Vehicle Dynamics vides the driver with a warning message
Control system automatically reacti- by sending a signal from a sensor that is
vates itself the next time the ignition installed in each wheel when tire pressure
switch is turned to the OFF position is severely low.
and the engine is restarted. The tire pressure monitoring system will
y If the switch is held down for 10 sec- activate only when the vehicle is driven at
onds or longer, the indicator light goes speeds above 20 mph (32 km/h). Also,
off, the Vehicle Dynamics Control sys- this system may not react immediately to
tem is activated, and the system ig- a sudden drop in tire pressure (for exam-
nores any further pressing of the ple, a blow-out caused by running over a
switch. To make the switch usable sharp object).
again, turn the ignition switch to the
OFF position and restart the engine.
y When the switch is pressed to deac-
– CONTINUED –
7-34 Starting and operating
Even when the vehicle is driven a If this light still comes on while driv-
very short distance, the tires get ing after adjusting the tire pressure,
If the low tire pressure warning light
warm and their pressures increase a tire may have significant damage
comes on while driving, never brake
accordingly. Be sure to let the tires and a fast leak that causes the tire to
suddenly and keep driving straight
cool thoroughly before adjusting lose air rapidly. If you have a flat tire,
ahead while gradually reducing
their pressures to the standard val- replace it with a spare tire as soon
speed. Then slowly pull off the road
ues shown on the tire placard. (Re- as possible. When a spare tire is
to a safe place. Otherwise an acci-
fer to the “Tires and wheels” section mounted or a wheel rim is replaced
dent involving serious vehicle dam-
in chapter 11.) The tire pressure without the original pressure sen-
age and serious personal injury
monitoring system does not func- sor/transmitter being transferred,
could occur.
tion when the vehicle is stationary. the low tire pressure warning light
Check the pressure for all four tires After adjusting the tire pressures, will flash. This indicates the TPMS is
and adjust the pressure to the COLD increase the vehicle speed to at unable to monitor all four road
tire pressure shown on the tire plac- least 20 mph (32 km/h) to start the wheels. Contact your SUBARU deal-
ard on the door pillar on the driver’s TPMS re-checking of the tire infla- er as soon as possible for tire and
side. tion pressures. If the tire pressures sensor replacement and/or system
are now above the severe low pres- resetting.
sure threshold, the low tire pressure Do not inject any tire liquid or aero-
warning light should go off a few sol tire sealant into the tires, as this
minutes later. may cause a malfunction of the tire
pressure sensors. If the light flash-
es, promptly contact a SUBARU
dealer to have the system inspect-
ed.
Starting and operating 7-35
To set cruise control vehicle reaches the desired speed. The vehicle will maintain the desired
0 speed.
Vehicle speed can be temporarily in-
creased while driving with the cruise con-
trol activated. Simply depress the acceler-
ator pedal to accelerate the vehicle. When
the accelerator pedal is released, the ve-
hicle will return to and maintain the previ-
ous cruising speed.
700161
300210
The “ ” indicator light on the com- 300212 y Pull the control lever in the “CANCEL”
bination meter will come on. direction.
At this time, the “ ” indicator light is il- y Depress the brake pedal.
2. Depress the accelerator pedal until the
luminated in the combination meter.
– CONTINUED –
7-38 Starting and operating
y Depress the clutch pedal (manual trans- To change the cruising speed T To increase the speed (by accelera-
mission vehicles only). tor pedal)
y Shift the selector lever into the “N” posi- T To increase the speed (by control le- 1. Depress the accelerator pedal to accel-
tion (automatic transmission vehicles ver) erate the vehicle to the desired speed.
only). 2. Push the control lever downward in the
y Shift the shift lever into neutral position “SET/COAST” direction once. Now the
(manual transmission vehicles only). desired speed is set and the vehicle will
The “ ” indicator light in the combina- keep running at that speed without de-
tion meter goes off when the cruise control pressing the accelerator pedal.
is cancelled. NOTE
To resume the cruise control after it has If the difference between the actual ve-
been temporarily canceled and with vehi- hicle speed when the control lever is
cle speed of approximately 20 mph (32 pushed downward and the speed last
km/h) or more, push the control lever up- time you set is less than 4 mph (6.8 km/
ward in the “RES/ACC” direction to return h), the vehicle speed will be lowered by
300334
to the original cruising speed automatical- 1 mph (1.6 km/h). This occurs because
ly. Push the control lever upward in the the cruise control system unit regards
The “ ” indicator light in the combina- “RES/ACC” direction and hold it until the this lever operation as that intended to
tion meter will automatically come on at vehicle reaches the desired speed. Then, decrease the vehicle speed.
this time. release the control lever. The vehicle
speed at that moment will be memorized
To turn off the cruise control and treated as the new set speed.
There are two ways to turn off the cruise When the difference between the actual
control: vehicle speed and the set speed is less
y Push the main switch again. than 4 mph (6.8 km/h), the set speed can
y Turn the ignition switch to the “ACC” or be increased 1 mph (1.6 km/h) each time
“LOCK” position (but only when the vehi- by pressing the control lever upward in the
cle is completely stopped). “RES/ACC” direction quickly within 0.25
second.
Starting and operating 7-39
T To decrease the speed (by control T To decrease the speed (by brake If you move the cruise control lever or
lever) pedal) press the main switch button while turning
1. Depress the brake pedal to release the ignition switch “ON”, the cruise control
cruise control temporarily. function is deactivated and the “CRUISE”
2. When the speed decreases to the de- indicator light flashes. To reactivate the
sired speed, press the control lever down- cruise control function, turn the ignition
ward in the “SET/COAST” direction once. switch back to the “ACC” or “LOCK” posi-
Now the desired speed is set and the ve- tion, and then turn it again to the “ON” po-
hicle will keep running at that speed with- sition.
out depressing the accelerator pedal.
Cruise control set indicator
Cruise control indicator light light
300333
New vehicle break-in driving – the first 1,000 Trailer hitches ......................................................... 8-24
miles (1,600 km) .............................................. 8-2 Connecting a trailer ................................................ 8-25
Trailer towing tips ................................................... 8-26
Fuel economy hints ........................................... 8-2
Engine exhaust gas (Carbon monoxide) ......... 8-2
Catalytic converter ............................................. 8-3
Periodic inspections .......................................... 8-4
Driving in foreign countries .............................. 8-4
Driving tips for AWD vehicles ........................... 8-5
Off road driving .................................................. 8-6
Winter driving ..................................................... 8-7
Operation during cold weather .............................. 8-7
Driving on snowy and icy roads ............................ 8-9
Corrosion protection .............................................. 8-10
Snow tires ............................................................... 8-10 8
Tire chains ............................................................... 8-11
Rocking the vehicle ................................................ 8-12
Loading your vehicle ......................................... 8-12
Vehicle capacity weight ......................................... 8-13
GVWR and GAWR (Gross Vehicle Weight Rating
and Gross Axle Weight Rating) ........................... 8-14
Roof rail and crossbar (if equipped) ..................... 8-14
Trailer hitch (if equipped) .................................. 8-18
Connecting a trailer ................................................ 8-19
When you do not tow a trailer ............................... 8-20
Trailer towing ...................................................... 8-20
Warranties and maintenance ................................. 8-20
Maximum load limits .............................................. 8-21
8-2 Driving tips
New vehicle break-in driving Fuel economy hints Engine exhaust gas (Carbon
Driving tips
800014
800235
3.0-liter models
2.5-liter non-turbo models
The catalytic converter is installed in the
exhaust system. It serves as catalyst to
– CONTINUED –
8-4 Driving tips
reduce HC, CO and NOx in exhaust gas- Periodic inspections Driving in foreign countries
es, thus providing cleaner exhaust.
To avoid damage to the catalytic convert- To keep your vehicle in the best condition When planning to use your vehicle in an-
er: at all times, always have the recommend- other country:
y Use only unleaded gasoline. Even a ed maintenance services listed in the y Confirm the availability of the correct fu-
small amount of leaded gasoline will dam- maintenance schedule in the “Warranty el. (Refer to the “Fuel requirements” sec-
age the catalytic converter. and Maintenance Booklet” performed at tion in chapter 7.)
y Never start the engine by pushing or the specified time or mileage intervals. y Comply with all regulations and require-
pulling the vehicle. ments of each country.
y Avoid racing the engine.
y Never turn off the ignition switch while
the vehicle is moving.
y Keep your engine tuned-up. If you feel
the engine running rough (misfiring, back-
firing or incomplete combustion), have
your vehicle checked and repaired by an
authorized SUBARU dealer.
y Do not apply undercoating or rust pre-
vention treatment to the heat shield of cat-
alytic converter and the exhaust system.
Driving tips 8-5
Driving tips for AWD vehicles provide better traction when driving on speedometer/odometer calibration, and
slippery, wet or snow-covered roads and clearance between the body and tires. It
when moving out of mud, dirt and sand. By also may be dangerous and lead to loss of
shifting power between the front and rear vehicle control.
wheels, SUBARU AWD can also provide y If you use a temporary spare tire to re-
y Always maintain a safe driving
added traction during acceleration, and place a flat tire, be sure to use the original
speed according to the road and
added engine braking force during decel- temporary spare tire stored in the vehicle.
weather conditions in order to
eration. Using other sizes may result in severe
avoid having an accident on a
Therefore, your SUBARU AWD vehicle mechanical damage to the drive train of
sharp turn, during sudden braking
may handle differently than an ordinary your vehicle.
or under other similar conditions.
two wheel drive vehicle and it contains y Always check the cold tire pressure be-
y Always use the utmost care in some features unique to AWD. For safety fore starting to drive. The recommended
driving – overconfidence because purposes as well as to avoid damaging tire pressure is provided on the tire plac-
you are driving an All-Wheel Drive the AWD system, you should keep the fol- ard, which is located under the door latch
vehicle could easily lead to a seri- lowing tips in mind: on the driver’s side.
ous accident. y Tire chains should always be placed on
y An AWD vehicle is better able to climb the front wheels only.
steeper roads under snowy or slippery y There are some precautions that you
conditions than a two wheel drive vehicle. must observe when towing your vehicle.
There is little difference in handling, how- For detail information, see “Towing” sec-
ever, during extremely sharp turns or sud- tion in chapter 9.
den braking. Therefore, when driving
down a slope or turning corners, be sure
to reduce your speed and maintain an am-
ple distance from other vehicles.
y When replacing a tire, make sure you
use only the same size, circumference,
construction, brand, and load range as the
original tires listed on the tire placard. Us-
800004
ing other sizes, circumferences or con-
All-Wheel Drive distributes the engine struction may result in severe mechanical
power to all four wheels. AWD vehicles damage to the drive train of your vehicle
and may affect ride, handling, braking,
8-6 Driving tips
Off road driving tions in the next section (applicable to the y Slow down and employ extra caution at
OUTBACK) for general guidance. But all times. When driving off-road, you will
please keep in mind that your vehicle’s not have the benefit of marked traffic
off-road capabilities are more limited than lanes, banked curves, traffic signs and the
those of the OUTBACK. like.
y Always maintain a safe driving
Never attempt to drive through pools and y Do not drive across steep slopes. In-
speed according to the road and
puddles, or roads flooded with water. Wa- stead, drive either straight up or straight
weather conditions in order to
ter entering the engine air intake or the ex- down the slopes. A vehicle can much
avoid having an accident on a
haust pipe or water splashing onto electri- more easily tip over sideways than it can
sharp turn, during sudden braking
cal parts may damage your vehicle and end over end. Avoid driving straight up or
or under other similar conditions.
may cause it to stall. down slopes that are too steep.
y Always use the utmost care in y Avoid sharp turning maneuvers, espe-
driving – overconfidence because T OUTBACK cially at higher speeds.
you are driving an All-Wheel Drive Because of the AWD feature and higher y Do not grip the inside or spokes of the
vehicle could easily lead to a seri- ground clearance, your SUBARU can be steering wheel. A bad bump could jerk the
ous accident. driven on ordinary roads or off-road. But wheel and injure your hands. Instead drive
please keep in mind that an AWD with your fingers and thumbs on the out-
T All AWD models except OUTBACK SUBARU is a passenger car and is nei- side of the rim.
Your AWD vehicle is neither a convention- ther a conventional off-road vehicle nor an y If driving through water, such as when
al off-road vehicle nor an all terrain vehi- all-terrain vehicle. If you do take your crossing shallow streams, first check the
cle. It is a passenger car designed prima- SUBARU off-road, certain common sense depth of the water and the bottom of the
rily for on-road use. The AWD feature precautions such as the following should stream bed for firmness and ensure that
gives it some limited off-road capabilities be taken: the bed of the stream is flat. Drive slowly
in situations in which driving surfaces a and completely through the stream. The
relatively level, obstruction-free and other- y Make certain that you and all of your
passengers are wearing seatbelts. water should be shallow enough that it
wise similar to on-road driving conditions. does not reach the vehicle’s undercar-
Operating it under other than those condi- y Carry some emergency equipment,
such as a towing rope or chain, a shovel, riage. Water entering the engine air intake
tions could subject the vehicle to exces- or the exhaust pipe or water splashing
sive stress which might result in damage wheel blocks, first aid kit and cell phone or
citizens band radio. onto electrical parts may damage your ve-
not eligible for repair under warranty. If hicle and may cause it to stall. Never at-
you do take your SUBARU off road, you y Drive carefully. Do not take unneces-
sary risks by driving in dangerous areas or tempt to drive through rushing water; re-
should review the common sense precau- gardless of its depth, it can wash away the
over rough terrain.
Driving tips 8-7
ground from under your tires, resulting in y If you must rock the vehicle to free it Winter driving
possible loss of traction and even vehicle from sand or mud, depress the accelera-
rollover. tor pedal slightly and move the selector le-
y Always check your brakes for effective- ver back and forth between “D” and “R” re-
ness immediately after driving in sand, peatedly. Do not race the engine. For the
mud or water. Do this by driving slowly best possible traction, avoid spinning the
and stepping on the brake pedal. Repeat wheels when trying to free the vehicle.
that process several times to dry out the y When the road surface is extremely
brake discs and brake pads. slippery, you can obtain better traction by
y Do not drive or park over or near flam- starting the vehicle with the transmission
mable materials such as dry grass or fall- in 2nd than 1st (both for MT and AT).
en leaves, as they may burn easily. The y Never equip your vehicle with tires larg-
exhaust system is very hot while the en- er than those specified in this manual.
gine is running and right after engine y Wash the vehicle’s underbody after off-
stops. This could create a fire hazard. road driving. Suspension components are 800015
y After driving through tall grass, mud, particularly prone to dirt buildup, so they
rocks, sand, rivers, etc., check that there need to be washed thoroughly. Operation during cold weath-
is no grass, bush, paper, rags, stones, y Frequent driving of an AWD vehicle un- er
sand, etc. adhering to or trapped on the der hard-driving conditions such as rough
underbody. Clear off any such matter from roads or off roads will necessitate more Carry some emergency equipment, such
the underbody. If the vehicle is used with frequent replacement of engine oil, brake as tire chains, a window scraper, a bag of
these materials trapped or adhering to the fluid and transmission oil than that speci- sand, flares, a small shovel, and jumper
underbody, a mechanical breakdown or fied in the maintenance schedule de- cables.
fire could occur. scribed in the “Warranty and Maintenance Check the battery and cables. Cold tem-
y Secure all cargo carried inside the vehi- Booklet”. peratures reduce battery capacity. The
cle and make certain that it is not piled battery must be in good condition to pro-
higher than the seatbacks. During sudden Remember that damage done to your
SUBARU while operating it off-road and vide enough power for cold winter starts.
stops or jolts, unsecured cargo could be
thrown around in the vehicle and cause in- not using common sense precautions Use an engine oil of proper grade and vis-
jury. Do not pile heavy loads on the roof. such as those listed above is not eligible cosity for cold weather. Heavy summer oil
Those loads raise the vehicle’s center of for warranty coverage. will cause harder starting.
gravity and make it more prone to tip over. Keep the door locks from freezing by
– CONTINUED –
8-8 Driving tips
squirting them with deicer or glycerin. the piping between the reservoir tank and do so and check under the fenders period-
washer nozzles by operating the washer ically.
Forcing a frozen door open may damage for a certain period of time. Otherwise, if
or separate the rubber weather strips the concentration of the fluid remaining in T Parking in cold weather
around the door. If the door is frozen, use the piping is too low for the outside tem-
hot water to melt the ice, and afterwards perature, it may freeze and block the noz-
thoroughly wipe the water away. zles.
Snow can trap dangerous exhaust
Use a windshield washer fluid that con- gases under your vehicle. Keep
tains an antifreeze solution. Do not use snow clear of the exhaust pipe and
engine antifreeze or other substitutes be- from around your vehicle if you park
cause they may damage the paint of the Adjust the washer fluid concentra-
tion appropriately for the outside the vehicle in snow with the engine
vehicle. running.
SUBARU Windshield Washer Fluid con- temperature. If the concentration is
tains 58.5% methyl alcohol and 41.5% inappropriate, sprayed washer fluid Do not use the parking brake when park-
surfactant, by volume. Its freezing temper- may freeze on the windshield and ing for long periods in cold weather since
ature varies according to how much it is di- obstruct your view, and the fluid it could freeze in that position. Instead, ob-
luted, as indicated in the following table. may freeze in the reservoir tank. serve the following.
T Before driving your vehicle 1. Place the shift lever in “1” or “R” for
Washer Fluid Freezing manual transmission vehicles, and in “P”
Concentration Temperature Before entering the vehicle, remove any for automatic transmission vehicles.
snow or ice from your shoes because that 2. Use tire stops under the tires to prevent
30% 10.4°F (–12°C) could make the pedals slippery and dan- the vehicle from moving.
50% –4°F (–20°C) gerous.
When the vehicle is parked in snow or
100% –49°F (–45°C) While warming up the vehicle before driv- when it snows, raise the wiper blades off
ing, check that the accelerator pedal, the glass to prevent damage to them.
In order to prevent freezing of washer flu- brake pedal, and all other controls operate
id, check the freezing temperatures in the smoothly. When the vehicle has been left parked af-
table above when adjusting the fluid con- ter use on roads heavily covered with
Clear away ice and snow that has accu- snow, or has been left parked during a
centration to the outside temperature. mulated under the fenders to avoid mak-
If you fill the reservoir tank with a fluid with snowstorm, icing may develop on the
ing steering difficult. During severe winter brake system, which could cause poor
a different concentration from the one driving, stop when and where it is safe to
used previously, purge the old fluid from braking action. Check for snow or ice
Driving tips 8-9
– CONTINUED –
8-10 Driving tips
wiper blades (winter blades) during the Snow tires y Do not use a combination of radi-
seasons you could have snow and sub- al, belted bias or bias tires since it
zero temperatures. Blades of this type T All models except OUTBACK
may cause dangerous handling
give superior wiping performance in characteristics and lead to an ac-
snowy conditions. Be sure to use blades cident.
that are suitable for your vehicle.
y When replacing original tires with Your vehicle is equipped with “all season
winter (snow) tires, make sure you tires” which are designed to provide an
use only the same size, construc- adequate measure of traction, handling
During high-speed driving, non- tion and load range as the original and braking performance in year-round
freezing type wiper blades may not tires listed on the tire placard. Us- driving. In winter, it may be possible to en-
perform as well as standard wiper ing other sizes and construction hance performance through use of tires
blades. If this happens, reduce the may affect speedometer/odome- designed specifically for winter driving
vehicle speed. ter calibration and clearance be- conditions.
tween the body and tires. It also If you choose to install winter tires on your
NOTE may be dangerous and lead to vehicle, be sure to use the correct tire size
When the season requiring non-freez- loss of vehicle control. and type. You must install four winter tires
ing type wiper blades is over, replace y You must install four winter tires that are of the same size, construction,
them with standard wiper blades. that are of the same size, circum- brand and load range and you should nev-
ferences, construction, brand, er mix radial, belted bias or bias tires since
Corrosion protection and load range. Mixing other siz- this may result in dangerous handling
Refer to the “Corrosion protection” section es, circumferences or construc- characteristics. When you choose a tire,
(chapter 10). tions may result in severe me- make sure that there is enough clearance
chanical damage to the drive train between the tire and vehicle body.
of your vehicle and may affect
Remember to drive with care at all times
ride, handling, braking and speed-
regardless of the type of tires on your ve-
ometer/odometer calibration. It
hicle.
also may be dangerous and lead
to loss of vehicle control.
Driving tips 8-11
require the use of tire chains, in which speed” and “Automatic transmission – 5- Loading your vehicle
case put the chains on the front wheels speed” section in chapter 7 for information
only. Use only SAE class S type chains on holding the transmission in 2nd posi-
that are of the correct size for your tires so tion.
as not to damage the vehicle body or sus-
Never allow passengers to ride on a
pension.
folded rear seatback, in the trunk or
When driving with tire chains, drive at
in the cargo area. Doing so may re-
speeds below 19 mph (30 km/h). When a
sult in serious injury.
temporary spare tire is on a front wheel,
replace the temporary spare tire with the
rear tire on the same side of the vehicle,
and then fit chains on the front tires.
Always use the utmost care when driving
with tire chains – overconfidence because
you are driving with tire chains could eas-
ily lead to a serious accident.
ward and causing serious injury The load capacity of your vehicle is deter-
during a sudden stop. mined by weight, not by available cargo
y Never exceed the maximum load space. The maximum load you can carry
limit. If you do, some parts on in your vehicle is shown on the vehicle
your vehicle can break, or it can placard attached to the driver’s side door
change the way your vehicle han- pillar. It includes the total weight of the
dles. This could result in loss of driver and all passengers and their be-
control and cause personal injury. longings, any optional equipment such as
Also, overloading can shorten the a trailer hitch, roof rack or bike carrier,
life of your vehicle. etc., and the tongue load of a trailer.
y Do not place anything on the rear
800236
shelf behind the rear seatback (for
Sedan) or the extended luggage
cover (for Station wagon). Such
items could tumble forward in the
event of a sudden stop or a colli-
sion. This could cause serious in-
jury.
– CONTINUED –
8-14 Driving tips
GVWR and GAWR (Gross Ve- GAWR. The front and rear GAWs can be Roof rail and crossbar (if
hicle Weight Rating and adjusted by relocating luggage inside the equipped)
vehicle.
Gross Axle Weight Rating) Even if the total weight of your luggage is
lower than the vehicle capacity weight, ei- 1
ther front or rear GAW may exceed the
GAWR, depending on the distribution of
the luggage.
When possible, the load should be evenly
distributed throughout the vehicle.
If you carry heavy loads in the vehicle, you
should confirm that GVW and front and
rear GAWs are within the GVWR and
GAWR by putting your vehicle on a vehi-
cle scale, found at a commercial weighing 800238
800237
station.
1) Crossbar kit
Certification label
Do not use replacement tires with a lower
load range than the originals because
The certification label attached to the driv- they may lower the GVWR and GAWR
er’s side door shows GVWR (Gross Vehi- limitations. Replacement tires with a high- y For cargo carrying purposes, the
cle Weight Rating) and GAWR (Gross er load range than the originals do not in- roof rail must be used together
Axle Weight Rating). crease the GVWR and GAWR limitations. with a roof crossbar kit and the
The GVW (Gross Vehicle Weight) must appropriate carrying attachment.
never exceed the GVWR. GVW is the The roof rail must never be used
combined total of weight of the vehicle, fu- alone to carry cargo. Otherwise,
el, driver, all passengers, luggage, any damage to the roof or paint or a
optional equipment and trailer tongue dangerous road hazard due to
load. Therefore, the GVW changes de- loss of cargo could result.
pending on the situation.
In addition, the total weight applied to
each axle (GAW) must never exceed the
Driving tips 8-15
y When using the roof crossbar kit, T Installing carrying attachments on V To remove the crossbar
make sure that the total weight of the crossbars
the crossbars, carrying attach- When installing any carrying attachment
ment and cargo does not exceed such as a bike carrier, ski carrier, kayak
the maximum load limit. Overload- carrier, cargo basket, etc. on the cross-
ing may cause damage to the ve- bars, follow the manufacturer’s instruc-
hicle and create a safety hazard. tions and make sure that the attachment is
securely fixed to the crossbars. Use only
The roof rail is not designed to carry cargo attachments designed specifically for the
by itself. Cargo can be carried after secur- crossbars. A set of the crossbars is de-
ing the roof crossbar kit to the roof rail and signed to carry loads (cargo and attach-
installing the appropriate carrying attach- ment) of not more than 100 lbs (45 kg).
ment. When installing the roof crossbar Before operating the vehicle, make sure
kit, follow the manufacturer’s instructions. that the cargo is properly secured on the 800239
When you carry cargo on the roof using attachment. 1. Loosen and remove the T-30 torx®
the roof crossbar kit and a carrying attach- NOTE head screw from the top of each crossbar
ment, never exceed the maximum load Remember that the vehicle’s center of end support.
limit explained in the following. You should gravity is altered with the weight of the Loosen the lower clamps.
also be careful that your vehicle does not load on the roof, thus affecting the
exceed the Gross Vehicle Weight Rating driving characteristics.
(GVWR) and front and rear Gross Axle Drive carefully. Avoid rapid starts, hard
Weight Rating (GAWR). See the “Loading cornering and abrupt stops. Crosswind
your vehicle” section in this chapter for in- effects will be increased.
formation on loading cargo into or onto
your vehicle. The maximum load limit of T Removal and installation of the
the cargo, crossbars and carrying attach- crossbars
ment must not exceed 100 lbs (45 kg). The crossbars can be removed when you
Place the heaviest load at the bottom, do not use the roof to carry cargo.
nearest the roof, and evenly distribute the
cargo. Always properly secure all cargo.
800240
– CONTINUED –
8-16 Driving tips
1
1
800242 800243
Rear crossbar:
1
1
800244 800245
800246
1) Lower clamp 6. Adjust the alignment of the crossbar on
2) T-30 torx® head screw the roof rails, and if available, use a T-30 1) Zero gap
torx® bit and torque wrench and tighten
5. Tighten the lower clamps onto the Install the rear cross bar so that the rear
the T-30 torx® head screws to 30 to 35
crossbar. Using a torque wrench, loosely edges of both crossbar end supports are
lbf·in (3.4 to 4.0 N·m, 0.35 to 0.41 kgf·m)
tighten the T-30 torx® head screws. aligned (zero gap) with the front edges of
of torque (or tighten securely with the
both rear roof rail supports.
NOTE torx® wrench provided).
It may be necessary to squeeze the Install the rear crossbar in the same man-
lower clamp and the end support to- ner as the front crossbar.
gether to compress the pads and gain
a better alignment of the pieces while
trying to start the screw. Use care not
to crossthread the screw in the insert. Do not carry cargo on the roof when
the crossbars are removed. Lug-
gage on the roof will be thrown for-
ward or backward in sudden stops
or rapid accelerations, resulting in a
dangerous road hazard.
– CONTINUED –
8-18 Driving tips
NOTE Trailer hitch (if equipped) y Be sure to check the hitch pin and
Before each use of the roof crossbar, safety pin for positive locking
make sure the four T-30 crossbar placement before towing a trailer.
clamp screws have been checked, and If the ball mount comes off the
retightened if necessary to 35 lbf·in (4.0 y Never exceed the maximum hitch receiver, the trailer could get
N·m, 0.41 kgf·m), as outlined in Step #5 weight specified for the trailer loose and create a traffic safety
above. hitch. Exceeding the maximum hazard.
weight could cause an accident y Use only the ball mount supplied
resulting in serious personal inju- with this hitch. Use the hitch only
ries. Permissible trailer weight as a weight carrying hitch. Do not
changes depending on the situa- use with any type of weight dis-
tion. Refer to the next section tributing hitch.
“Trailer towing” for possible rec-
ommendations and limitations. The trailer hitch is designed to tow a Class
1 rated load. The maximum gross trailer
y Trailer brakes are required when weight and maximum gross tongue weight
the towing load exceeds 1,000 lbs are indicated in the following table.
(453 kg). Be sure your trailer has
safety chains and that each chain
Maximum Maximum
will hold the trailer’s maximum gross trailer gross tongue
gross weight. Towing trailers weight weight
without safety chains could create
a traffic safety hazard if the trailer 3.0-liter 3,000 lbs
separates from the hitch due to models (1,360 kg)
coupling damage or hitch ball 200 lbs
All models 2,700 lbs
damage. (90 kg)
other than (1,224 kg)
3.0-liter
models
800209
2
800208
required due to the additional load. (Refer y Before towing a trailer, check the
to “Maintenance schedule under severe trailer total weight, GVW, GAWs
driving conditions” in the “Warranty and and tongue load. Make sure the
Maintenance Booklet”.) load and its distribution in your
Under no circumstances should a trailer vehicle and trailer are acceptable.
be towed with a new vehicle or a vehicle
with any new powertrain component (en- T Total trailer weight
gine, transmission, differential, wheel
bearings, etc.) for the first 1,000 miles
(1,600 km) of driving.
– CONTINUED –
8-22 Driving tips
When towing a trailer on a long uphill grade con- 1,500 lbs (680 kg)
tinuously for over 5 miles (8 km) with an outside
temperature of 104°F (40°C) or above.
MT models When towing a trailer without brakes. 1,000 lbs (453 kg) 800247
When towing a trailer with brakes. 2,700 lbs (1,224 kg) Gross Vehicle Weight
AT models When towing a trailer without brakes. 1,000 lbs (453 kg) The Gross Vehicle Weight (GVW) must
never exceed the Gross Vehicle Weight
When towing a trailer with brakes. 2,700 lbs (1,224 kg) Rating (GVWR).
When towing a trailer on a long uphill 1,350 lbs (612 kg) Gross Vehicle Weight (GVW) is the com-
grade continuously for over 5 miles (8 bined total of the weight of the vehicle,
km) with an outside temperature of driver, passengers, luggage, trailer hitch,
104°F (40°C) or above. trailer tongue load and any other optional
equipment installed on your vehicle.
Therefore, the GVW changes depending
on the situation. Determine the GVW each
time before going on a trip by putting your
vehicle and trailer on a vehicle scale.
GVWR is shown on the certification label
located on the driver’s door of your vehi-
Driving tips 8-23
800237 800214
– CONTINUED –
8-24 Driving tips
Trailer hitches
1 2
F
Never drill the frame or under-body
60%
of your vehicle to install a commer-
40% 50% 50% cial trailer hitch. If you do, danger-
ous exhaust gas, water or mud may
enter the passenger compartment
through the drilled hole. Exhaust
gas contains carbon monoxide, a
colorless and odorless gas which is
800250 800216
dangerous, or even lethal, if inhaled.
1) Jack F: Front Also, drilling the frame or under-
2) Bathroom scale body of your vehicle could cause
The tongue load can be adjusted by prop- deterioration of strength of your ve-
The tongue load can be weighed with a er distribution of the load in the trailer. hicle and cause corrosion around
bathroom scale as shown in the following Never load the trailer with more weight in the drilled hole.
illustration. When weighing the tongue the back than in the front; approximately
load, be sure to position the towing cou- 60 percent of the trailer load should be in
pler at the height at which it would be dur- the front and approximately 40 percent in
ing actual towing, using a jack as shown. the rear. Also, distribute the load as even- y Do not modify the vehicle exhaust
ly as possible on both the left and right system, brake system, or other
sides. systems when installing a hitch or
Be sure that all cargo is firmly secured to other trailer towing equipment.
prevent a change in weight distribution
y Do not use axle-mounted hitches
while driving.
as they can cause damage to the
axle housing, wheel bearings,
wheels or tires.
Choose a proper hitch for your vehicle and
trailer.
Driving tips 8-25
T OUTBACK wagon bolts and nuts are tight. fessional trailer supplier for more informa-
The use of a genuine SUBARU trailer tion about the trailer’s brake system.
hitch is recommended. A genuine Connecting a trailer T Trailer safety chains
SUBARU hitch is available from your
SUBARU dealer. T Trailer brakes
If use of a non-genuine hitch is unavoid-
able, be sure the hitch is suited to your ve- Always use safety chains between
hicle and trailer. Consult with a profes- your vehicle and the trailer. Towing
sional hitch supplier to assist you in y Adequate size trailer brakes are
required when the trailer and its trailer without safety chains could
choosing an appropriate hitch for your ve- create a traffic safety hazard if the
hicle. Be sure to follow all of the hitch man- cargo exceed 1,000 lbs (453 kg)
total weight. trailer separates from the hitch due
ufacturer’s instructions for installation and to coupling damage or hitch ball
use. y Do not directly connect your trail- damage.
Never use a hitch that mounts only to the er’s hydraulic brake system to the
rear bumper. The bumper is not designed hydraulic brake system in your In case the trailer hitch connector or hitch
to handle that type of load. vehicle. Direct connection would ball should break or become disconnect-
For all types of hitches, regularly check cause the vehicle’s brake perfor- ed, the trailer could get loose and create a
that the hitch mounting bolts and nuts are mance to deteriorate and could traffic safety hazard.
tight. lead to an accident. For safety, always connect the towing ve-
hicle and trailer with trailer safety chains.
T All vehicles except OUTBACK wag- If your trailer’s total weight (trailer weight Pass the chains crossing each other un-
on plus its cargo weight) exceeds 1,000 lbs der the trailer tongue to prevent the trailer
SUBARU does not offer accessory trailer (453 kg), the trailer is required to be from dropping onto the ground in case the
hitches. Consult with a professional hitch equipped with its own brake system. Elec- trailer tongue should disconnect from the
supplier to assist you in choosing an ap- tric brakes or surge brakes are recom- hitch ball. Allow sufficient slack in the
propriate hitch for your vehicle. Be sure to mended, and must be installed properly. chains taking tight-turn situations into ac-
follow all of the hitch manufacturer’s in- Check that your trailer’s brakes conform count; however, be careful not to let them
structions for installation and use. with Federal, state/province and/or other drag on the ground.
Never use a hitch that mounts only to the applicable regulations. Your SUBARU’s For more information about the safety
rear bumper. The bumper is not designed brake system is not designed to be tapped chain connection, refer to the instructions
to handle that type of load. into the trailer’s hydraulic brake system. for your hitch and trailer.
Regularly check that the hitch mounting Please ask your SUBARU dealer and pro-
– CONTINUED –
8-26 Driving tips
T Side mirrors Connection of trailer lights to your vehi- maintained in the front tires.
cle’s electrical system requires modifica-
tions to the vehicle’s lighting circuit to in- Trailer tire condition, size, load rating and
crease its capacity and accommodate wir- proper inflation pressure should be in ac-
ing changes. To ensure the trailer lights cordance with the trailer manufacturer’s
are connected properly, please consult specifications.
your SUBARU dealer. Check for proper In the event your vehicle gets a flat tire
operation of the turn signals, the brake when towing a trailer, ask a commercial
lights and parking lights each time you road service to repair the flat tire.
hitch up.
If you carry a regular size spare tire in your
T Tires vehicle or trailer as a precaution against
getting a flat tire, be sure that the spare
800018 tire is firmly secured.
After hitching a trailer to your vehicle, Never tow a trailer when the tempo-
check that the standard side mirrors pro- rary spare tire is used. The tempo- Trailer towing tips
vide a good rearward field of view without rary spare tire is not designed to
significant blind spots. If significant blind sustain the towing load. Use of the
spots occur with the vehicle’s standard temporary spare tire when towing
side mirrors, use towing mirrors that con- can result in failure of the spare tire y Never exceed 45 mph (72 km/h)
form with Federal, state/province and/or and/or less stability of the vehicle. when towing a trailer in hilly coun-
other applicable regulations. try on hot days.
Make sure that all the tires on your vehicle y When towing a trailer, steering,
T Trailer lights are properly inflated. stability, stopping distance and
The recommended cold tire pressure un- braking performance will be dif-
der trailer towing conditions is shown in ferent from normal operation. For
chapter 12, “Specifications” and in “GAS safety’s sake, you should employ
Direct splicing or other improper extra caution when towing a trail-
connection of trailer lights may STATION REFERENCE” at the end of this
manual. Adjust the rear tire pressure to er and you should never speed.
damage your vehicle’s electrical You should also keep the follow-
system and cause a malfunction of the recommended pressure when the tires
are cold. Normal pressure should be ing tips in mind:
your vehicle’s lighting system.
Driving tips 8-27
T Before starting out on a trip the “feel” of the vehicle/trailer combination added weight and length caused by at-
y Check that the vehicle and vehicle-to- before starting out on a trip. In an area free taching the trailer to your vehicle.
hitch mounting are in good condition. If of traffic, practice turning, stopping and
backing up. 1 2
any problems are apparent, do not tow the
trailer. T Driving with a trailer
y Check that the vehicle sits horizontally
with the trailer attached. If the vehicle is y You should allow for considerably more
tipped sharply up at the front and down at stopping distance when towing a trailer.
the rear, check the total trailer weight, Avoid sudden braking because it may re-
GVW, GAWs and tongue load again, then sult in skidding or jackknifing and loss of
confirm that the load and its distribution control.
are acceptable. y Avoid abrupt starts and sudden acceler-
y Check that the tire pressures are cor- ations. If your vehicle has a manual trans-
rect. mission, always start out in first gear and
y Check that the vehicle and trailer are release the clutch at moderate engine rev- 800251
If you park your vehicle in an the turn signals do not work. Temporary spare tire
In case of emergency
emergency
600122
1
2 3
Station wagon 1. Lift the handle of the floor cover and 4. Take out the jack and tool bucket.
1) Jack handle hook the handle onto the trunk edge.
2) Jack and tool bucket
3) Spare tire
1
5. Take out the spare tire, jack, and jack
handle.
The spare tire and jack are stored under
the floor of the trunk or cargo area.
To remove the spare tire and jack, pro-
ceed as follows:
Sedan:
2
900245
600115
1) Wheel nut wrench
2. Remove the jack handle from the back 2) Jack
of the floor cover.
5. Take the wheel nut wrench and jack
3. Take out the storage tray.
out of the tool bucket.
– CONTINUED –
9-6 In case of emergency
600113 900257
600117
6. Turn the attaching bolt counterclock- 4. Take out the jack and tool bucket.
wise, then take the spare tire out. 2. Remove the left-hand part of the lid
and take out the jack handle.
Station wagon:
1
2
900245
600111
1) Wheel nut wrench
600110 2) Jack
3. Take out the storage tray.
1. Open the lid and hang the hook provid- 5. Take the wheel nut wrench and jack
ed on the under side of the lid on the rear out of the tool bucket.
In case of emergency 9-7
6. Turn the attaching bolt counterclock- 7. Loosen the wheel nuts using the wheel Turn the jackscrew by hand until the jack
wise, then take spare tire out. nut wrench but do not remove the nuts. head engages firmly into the jack-up point.
If the spare tire provided in your vehicle is
a temporary spare tire, carefully read the
section “Temporary spare tire” in this
chapter and strictly follow the instructions.
NOTE
Make sure the jack is well lubricated
before using it.
600123 600198
8. Place the jack under the side sill at the 9. Insert the jack handle into the jack-
front or rear jack-up point closest to the flat screw, and turn the handle until the tire
tire. clears the ground. Do not raise the vehicle
higher than necessary.
– CONTINUED –
9-8 In case of emergency
10.Remove the wheel nuts and the flat wheel nuts. Tighten them by hand. proximately 88 to 110 lbs (40 to 50 kg) at
tire. the top of the wheel nut wrench. Never
use your foot on the wheel nut wrench or
a pipe extension on the wrench because
Do not use oil or grease on the you may exceed the specified torque.
wheel studs or nuts when the spare Have the wheel nut torque checked at the
tire is installed. This could cause the nearest automotive service facility.
nuts to become loose and lead to an
accident.
13.Turn the jack handle counterclockwise
to lower the vehicle.
900009
4 2
1
600126
5
3
15.Store the flat tire in the spare tire com-
partment.
Put the spacer and tighten the attaching
600192 bolt firmly.
Also store the jack and jack handle in their
14.Use the wheel nut wrench to securely storage locations.
tighten the wheel nuts to the specified
600162 torque, following the tightening order in
the illustration.
11.Before putting the spare tire on, clean The torque for tightening the nuts is 74 to
the mounting surface of the wheel and 89 lbf·ft (100 to 120 N·m, 10 to 12 kgf·m).
hub with a cloth. This torque is equivalent to applying ap-
12.Put on the spare tire. Replace the
In case of emergency 9-9
activate only when the vehicle is driven. When a spare tire is mounted or a
Also, this system may not react immedi- wheel rim is replaced without the
Never place a tire or tire changing ately to a sudden drop in tire pressure (for original pressure sensor/transmitter
tools in the passenger compartment example, a blow-out caused running over being transferred, the low tire pres-
after changing wheels. In a sudden a sharp object). sure warning light will flash. This in-
stop or collisions, loose equipment dicates the TPMS is unable to moni-
could strike occupants and cause tor all four road wheels. Contact
injury. Store the tire and all tools in your SUBARU dealer as soon as
the proper place. If the low tire pressure warning light possible for tire and sensor replace-
comes on while driving, never brake ment and/or system resetting.
suddenly and keep driving straight
Tire pressure monitoring sys- ahead while gradually reducing Do not inject any tire liquid or aero-
tem (TPMS) (if equipped) speed. Then slowly pull off the road sol tire sealant into the tires, as this
to a safe place. Otherwise an acci- may cause a malfunction of the tire
dent involving serious vehicle dam- pressure sensors.
age and serious personal injury If the light flashes, promptly contact
could occur. a SUBARU dealer to have the sys-
Check the pressure for all four tires tem inspected.
and adjust the pressure to the COLD
tire pressure shown on the vehicle
placard on the door pillar on the
driver’s side. If this light still comes
on while driving after adjusting the
tire pressure, a tire may have signif-
icant damage and a fast leak that
700352
causes the tire to lose air rapidly. If
The tire pressure monitoring system pro- you have a flat tire, replace it with a
vides the driver with the warning message spare tire as soon as possible.
indicated by sending a signal from a sen-
sor that is installed in each wheel when
tire pressure is severely low.
The tire pressure monitoring system will
9-10 In case of emergency
600155
– CONTINUED –
9-12 In case of emergency
5. Start the engine of the vehicle with the Engine overheating the engine and contact your authorized
booster battery and run it at moderate dealer for repair.
speed. Then start the engine of the vehi- 3. After the engine coolant temperature
cle that has the discharged battery. has dropped, turn off the engine.
6. When finished, carefully disconnect the If the temperature gauge stays at the
Never attempt to remove the radia-
cables in exactly the reverse order. overheated zone, turn off the engine.
tor cap until the engine has been
4. After the engine has fully cooled down,
shut off and has fully cooled down.
check the coolant level in the reserve
When the engine is hot, the coolant
tank.
is under pressure. Removing the
If the coolant level is below the “MIN”
cap while the engine is still hot
mark, add coolant up to the “MAX” mark.
could release a spray of boiling hot
5. If there is no coolant in the reserve
coolant, which could burn you very
tank, add coolant to the reserve tank.
seriously.
Then remove the radiator cap and fill the
If the engine overheats, pull off the road radiator with coolant.
safely and stop the vehicle in a safe place. If you remove the radiator cap from a hot
radiator, first wrap a thick cloth around the
If steam is coming from the radiator cap, then turn the cap counter-
engine compartment clockwise slowly without pressing down
Turn off the engine and get everyone until it stops. Release the pressure from
away from the vehicle until it cools down. the radiator. After the pressure has been
fully released, remove the cap by pressing
down and turning it.
If no steam is coming from
the engine compartment
1. Keep the engine running at idling
speed.
2. Open the hood to ventilate the engine
compartment.
Confirm that the cooling fan is turning. If
the fan is not turning, immediately turn off
In case of emergency 9-13
900030
– CONTINUED –
9-14 In case of emergency
4. Screw the towing hook into the thread 4. Likewise, insert the screwdriver still
hole until the threads can no longer be wrapped with cloth or vinyl into the cutout
seen. between the towing hook cover and the
bumper. Pry out the cover.
900249
900250
In case of emergency 9-15
900252 900253
6. Tighten the towing hook securely using The front tie-down hooks are located be-
a wheel nut wrench. 600150
tween each of the front tires and the front
bumper.
After towing, remove the towing hook from
the vehicle and stow it in the tool bag. Rear tie-down hooks:
Fit the fog light cover and towing hook
cover on the bumper. Never use the rear towing hook to tie
the vehicle down.
Front tie-down hooks:
y Do not use the towing hook ex-
cept when towing your vehicle.
y Be sure to remove the towing
hook after towing. Leaving the
towing hook mounted on the vehi-
cle could interfere with proper op-
eration of the SRS airbag system 900032
in a frontal collision.
The rear tie-down hooks are located near
– CONTINUED –
9-16 In case of emergency
each of the jack-up reinforcements. 2. Pull up the parking brake lever firmly. y Remember that the brake booster
3. Secure the vehicle onto the carrier and power steering do not func-
properly with safety chains. Each safety tion when the engine is not run-
chain should be equally tightened and ning. Because the engine is
Use the rear tie-down hooks only for care must be taken not to pull the chains turned off, it will take greater ef-
downward anchoring. If they are so tightly that the suspension bottoms out. fort to operate the brake pedal and
used to anchor the vehicle in any steering wheel.
other direction, cables may slip off Towing with all wheels on the
the hooks, possibly causing a dan-
gerous situation. ground
y If transmission failure occurs,
Using a flat-bed truck transport your vehicle on a flat-
bed truck.
y Do not run the engine while being
towed using this method. Trans-
mission damage could result if
the vehicle is towed with the en-
gine running.
y For vehicles with automatic trans-
mission, the traveling speed must
900254
be limited to less than 20 mph (30
km/h) and the traveling distance
to less than 31 miles (50 km). For
900033 greater speeds and distances,
transport your vehicle on a flat-
y Never turn the ignition switch to
This is the best way to transport your vehi- bed truck.
the “LOCK” position while the ve-
cle. Use the following procedures to en-
hicle is being towed because the 1. Check the transmission and differential
sure safe transportation.
steering wheel and the direction oil levels and add oil to bring it to the upper
1. Shift the selector lever into the “P” po-
of the wheels will be locked. level if necessary.
sition for automatic transmission vehicles
or “1st” for manual transmission vehicles. 2. Release the parking brake and put the
transmission in neutral.
In case of emergency 9-17
200262
200261
Maintenance tools
Jack
A jack and other maintenance tools are
stored in the tool bucket in the center of
the spare tire located in the trunk or in the
cargo area.
900257 900258
Station wagon: To take out the jack and Sedan: Open the floor cover and remove
maintenance tools, open the center lid the jack handle from the back of the floor
and remove the bucket from the center of cover.
the spare tire. Then, take the jack out of
the bucket.
900244
Jack handle
Sedan: To take out the jack and mainte- The jack handle is stowed on the back of
nance tools, open the floor cover and re- the floor cover of the trunk or on the back
move the bucket from the center of the of the center lid of the cargo area.
spare tire. Then, take the jack out of the
bucket.
600117
900259
Screwdriver
Towing hook
Wheel nut wrench
Appearance care
10
10-2 Appearance care
NOTE mended that a coat of wax be applied at is left on too long, it may be difficult to
Be careful not to damage brake hoses, least once a month, or whenever the sur- clean off.
sensor harnesses, and other parts face no longer repels water. y Do not use soap containing grit to clean
when washing suspension compo- the wheels. Be sure to use a neutral clean-
If the appearance of the paint has dimin- ing agent, and later rinse thoroughly with
nents. ished to the point where the luster or tone water. Do not clean the wheels with a stiff
T Using a warm water washer cannot be restored, lightly polish the sur- brush or expose them to a high-speed
y Keep a good distance of 12 in (30 cm) face with a fine-grained compound. Never washing device.
or more between the washer nozzle and polish just the affected area, but include y Clean the vehicle (including the alumi-
the vehicle. the surrounding area as well. Always pol- num wheels) with water as soon as possi-
y Do not wash the same area continuous- ish in only one direction. A No. 2000 grain ble when it has been splashed with sea
ly. compound is recommended. Never use a water, exposed to sea breezes, or driven
coarse-grained compound. Coarser
y If a stain will not come out easily, wash on roads treated with salt or other agents.
by hand. Some warm water washers are grained compounds have a smaller grain-
size number and could damage the paint.
of the high temperature, high pressure
After polishing with a compound, coat with
type, and they can damage or deform the
resin parts such as mouldings, or cause wax to restore the original luster. Frequent
water to leak into the vehicle. polishing with a compound or an incorrect
polishing technique will result in removing
the paint layer and exposing the under-
Waxing and polishing coat. When in doubt, it is always best to
Always wash and dry the vehicle before contact your SUBARU dealer or an auto
waxing and polishing. paint specialist.
Use a good quality polish and wax and ap-
ply them according to the manufacturer’s NOTE
instructions. Wax or polish when the paint- Be careful not to block the windshield
ed surface is cool. washer nozzles with wax when waxing
the vehicle.
Be sure to polish and wax the chrome trim,
as well as the painted surfaces. Loss of Cleaning aluminum wheels
wax on a painted surface leads to loss of
the original luster and also quickens the y Promptly wipe the aluminum wheels
deterioration of the surface. It is recom- clean of any kind of grime or agent. If dirt
10-4 Appearance care
Corrosion protection other parts of the vehicle may be dry. soon as you find them.
4. High temperatures will cause corrosion
to parts of the vehicle which cannot dry Check the interior of the vehicle for water
Your SUBARU has been designed and and dirt accumulation under the floor mats
built to resist corrosion. Special materials quickly due to lack of proper ventilation.
because that could cause corrosion. Oc-
and protective finishes have been used on casionally check under the mats to make
most parts of the vehicle to help maintain To help prevent corrosion sure the area is dry.
fine appearance, strength, and reliable Wash the vehicle regularly to prevent cor-
operation. rosion of the body and suspension com- Keep your garage dry. Do not park your
ponents. Also, wash the vehicle promptly vehicle in a damp, poorly ventilated ga-
Most common causes of cor- after driving on any of the following surfac- rage. In such a garage, corrosion can be
es: caused by dampness. If you wash the ve-
rosion hicle in the garage or put the vehicle into
The most common causes of corrosion y roads that have been salted to prevent
them from freezing in winter the garage when wet or covered with
are: snow, that can cause dampness.
1. The accumulation of moisture retaining y mud, sand, or gravel
dirt and debris in body panel sections, y coastal roads If your vehicle is operated in cold weather
cavities, and other areas. After the winter has ended, it is recom- and/or in areas where road salts and other
2. Damage to paint and other protective mended that the underbody be given a corrosive materials are used, the door
coatings caused by gravel and stone very thorough washing. hinges and locks, trunk lid lock, and hood
chips or minor accidents. latch should be inspected and lubricated
Before the beginning of winter, check the periodically.
Corrosion is accelerated on the vehicle condition of underbody components, such
when: as the exhaust system, fuel and brake
1. It is exposed to road salt or dust control lines, brake cables, suspension, steering
chemicals, or used in coastal areas where system, floor pan, and fenders. If any of
there is more salt in the air, or in areas them are found to be rusted, they should
where there is considerable industrial pol- be given an appropriate rust prevention
lution. treatment or should be replaced. Contact
2. It is driven in areas of high humidity, es- your SUBARU dealer to perform this kind
pecially when temperatures range just of maintenance and treatment if you need
above freezing. assistance.
3. Dampness in certain parts of the vehi-
cle remains for a long time, even though Repair chips and scratches in the paint as
Appearance care 10-5
Cleaning the interior quality natural product which will retain its off with a clean, damp cloth. Commercial
distinctive appearance and feel for many foam-type cleaners suitable for synthetic
Use a soft, damp cloth to clean the climate years with proper care. leather materials may be used when nec-
control panel, audio equipment, instru- Allowing dust or road dirt to build up on the essary.
ment panel, center console, combination surface can cause the material to become
brittle and to wear prematurely. Regular NOTE
meter panel, and switches. (Do not use or- Strong cleaning agents such as sol-
ganic solvents.) cleaning with a soft, moist, natural fiber
cloth should be performed monthly, taking vents, paint thinners, window cleaner
care not to soak the leather or allow water or gasoline must never be used on
Seat fabric to penetrate the stitched seams. leather or synthetic interior materials.
Remove loose dirt, dust or debris with a A mild detergent suitable for cleaning
vacuum cleaner. If the dirt is caked on the woolen fabrics may be used to remove dif- Climate control panel, audio
fabric or hard to remove with a vacuum ficult dirt spots, rubbing with a soft, dry panel, instrument panel, con-
cleaner, use a soft blush then vacuum it. cloth afterwards to restore the luster. If
Wipe the fabric surface with a tightly sole panel, switches, combi-
your SUBARU is to be parked for a long
wrung cloth and dry the seat fabric thor- time in bright sunlight, it is recommended nation meter, and other plas-
oughly. If the fabric is still dirty, wipe using that the seats and headrests be covered, tic surface
a solution of mild soap and lukewarm wa- or the windows shaded, to prevent fading Use a soft, damp cloth to clean the climate
ter then dry thoroughly. or shrinkage. control panel, audio equipment, instru-
If the stain does not come out, try a com- Minor surface blemishes or bald patches ment panel, center console, combination
mercially-available fabric cleaner. Use the may be treated with a commercial leather meter panel, and switches.
cleaner on a hidden place and make sure spray lacquer. You will discover that each
leather seat section will develop soft folds NOTE
it does not affect the fabric adversely. Use Do not use organic solvents such as
the cleaner according to its instructions. or wrinkles, which is characteristic of gen-
uine leather. paint thinners or gasoline, or strong
NOTE cleaning agents that contain those sol-
vents.
When cleaning the seat, do not use Synthetic leather upholstery
benzine, paint thinner, or any similar
The synthetic leather material used on the
materials.
SUBARU may be cleaned using mild soap
or detergent and water, after first vacuum-
Leather seat materials ing or brushing away loose dirt. Allow the
The leather used by SUBARU is a high soap to soak in for a few minutes and wipe
Maintenance and service
Maintenance schedule ....................................... 11-3 Checking the oil level ............................................. 11-20
Maintenance precautions .................................. 11-3 Recommended grade and viscosity ..................... 11-21
Before checking or servicing in the engine Automatic transmission fluid ............................ 11-22
compartment ........................................................ 11-4 Checking the fluid level .......................................... 11-22
When you do checking or servicing in the engine Recommended fluid ............................................... 11-23
compartment while the engine is running ......... 11-4 Front differential gear oil (AT vehicles) ............ 11-23
Engine hood ....................................................... 11-4 Checking the oil level ............................................. 11-23
Engine compartment overview ......................... 11-6 Recommended grade and viscosity ..................... 11-24
2.5-liter non-turbo models ..................................... 11-6 Rear differential gear oil .................................... 11-24
2.5-liter turbo models ............................................. 11-7 Checking the gear oil level .................................... 11-24
3.0-liter models ....................................................... 11-8 Recommended grade and viscosity ..................... 11-26
Engine oil ............................................................ 11-9 Power steering fluid ........................................... 11-27
Checking the oil level ............................................. 11-9 Checking the fluid level .......................................... 11-27
Changing the oil and oil filter ................................ 11-10 Recommended fluid ............................................... 11-27
Recommended grade and viscosity ..................... 11-12 Brake fluid ........................................................... 11-28
Recommended grade and viscosity under severe Checking the fluid level .......................................... 11-28
driving conditions ................................................ 11-13 Recommended brake fluid ..................................... 11-28
Cooling system .................................................. 11-13 Clutch fluid (MT vehicles) .................................. 11-29
Hose and connections ........................................... 11-14 Checking the fluid level .......................................... 11-29
Engine coolant ........................................................ 11-14 Recommended clutch fluid .................................... 11-29
Air cleaner element ............................................ 11-17 Brake booster ..................................................... 11-30
Replacing the air cleaner element ......................... 11-17
Brake pedal ......................................................... 11-30 11
Spark plugs ......................................................... 11-19 Checking the brake pedal free play ...................... 11-30
Recommended spark plugs ................................... 11-19 Checking the brake pedal reserve distance ......... 11-30
Drive belts ........................................................... 11-20 Clutch pedal (Manual transmission
2.5-liter models ....................................................... 11-20 vehicles) ........................................................... 11-31
3.0-liter models ....................................................... 11-20 Checking the clutch function ................................ 11-31
Manual transmission oil .................................... 11-20 Checking the clutch pedal free play ..................... 11-31
Maintenance and service
Replacement of brake pad and lining ............... 11-31 Rear combination lights ......................................... 11-51
Breaking-in of new brake pads and linings ......... 11-32 Backup light (Station wagon) ................................ 11-52
Parking brake stroke .......................................... 11-32 License plate light .................................................. 11-53
Dome light ............................................................... 11-53
Tires and wheels ................................................ 11-33 Map light .................................................................. 11-54
Types of tires .......................................................... 11-33 Door step light ........................................................ 11-54
Tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS) Cargo area light (Station wagon) .......................... 11-55
(if equipped) .......................................................... 11-33 Trunk light (Sedan) ................................................. 11-55
Tire inspection ........................................................ 11-34 High mount stop light (Sedan) .............................. 11-56
Tire pressures and wear ........................................ 11-35
Wheel balance ........................................................ 11-37
Wear indicators ....................................................... 11-37
Tire rotation ............................................................. 11-37
Tire replacement ..................................................... 11-38
Wheel replacement ................................................. 11-38
Aluminum wheels ............................................... 11-39
Windshield washer fluid .................................... 11-39
Replacement of wiper blades ............................ 11-41
Windshield wiper blade assembly ........................ 11-41
Windshield wiper blade rubber ............................. 11-42
Rear window wiper blade assembly ..................... 11-42
Rear window wiper blade rubber .......................... 11-43
Battery ................................................................. 11-44
Fuses ................................................................... 11-45
Main fuse ............................................................. 11-47
Installation of accessories ................................ 11-47
Replacing bulbs .................................................. 11-48
Headlight ................................................................. 11-49
Parking light ............................................................ 11-50
Front turn signal light ............................................ 11-50
Front fog light (if equipped) ................................... 11-50
Maintenance and service 11-3
– CONTINUED –
11-4 Maintenance and service
y Wear adequate eye protection to y Always let the engine cool down. Engine hood
guard against getting oil or fluids Engine parts become very hot
in your eyes. If something does when the engine is running and
get in your eyes, thoroughly wash remain hot for some time after the
them out with clean water. engine is stopped.
y Do not tamper with the wiring of y Do not spill engine oil, engine
the SRS airbag system or seatbelt coolant, brake fluid or any other
pretensioner system, or attempt fluid on hot engine components.
to take its connectors apart, as This may cause a fire.
that may activate the system or it y Always remove the key from the
can render it inoperative. The wir- ignition switch. When the ignition
ing and connectors of these sys- switch is in the “ON” position, the
tems are yellow for easy identifi- cooling fan may operate suddenly
cation. NEVER use a circuit tester even when the engine is stopped. B00099
for these wiring.
If your SRS airbag or seatbelt pre- To open the hood:
tensioner needs service, consult When you do checking or ser- 1. If the wiper blades are lifted off the
your nearest SUBARU dealer. vicing in the engine compart- windshield, return them to their original
ment while the engine is run- positions.
Before checking or servicing ning 2. Pull the hood release knob under the
instrument panel.
in the engine compartment
200258
If this does not close the hood, release it
from a slightly higher position. Do not
3. Release the secondary hood release push the hood forcibly to close it. It could
located under the front grille by moving deform the metal.
the lever toward the left.
200259
13 12 11 10 9 8 7
B00414
Maintenance and service 11-7
13 12 11 10 9 8 7
B00416
– CONTINUED –
11-8 Maintenance and service
7 6
12 11 10 9 8 B00502
Maintenance and service 11-9
Engine oil
Checking the oil level 1
Check the engine oil level at each fuel 2
stop. 1
1. Park the vehicle on a level surface and
stop the engine.
3
2
B00418 B00417
– CONTINUED –
11-10 Maintenance and service
If you check the oil level just after stopping 3. Remove the oil filler cap. the drain plug while the engine is still
the engine, wait a few minutes for the oil to warm. The used oil should be drained into
drain back into the oil pan before checking an appropriate container and disposed of
the level. properly.
To prevent overfilling the engine oil, do not
add any additional oil above the upper lev-
el when the engine is cold.
Be careful not to burn yourself with
In 2.5-liter-engine models, the dipstick has hot engine oil.
a notch above the upper level.
Just after driving or while the engine is 5. Wipe the seating surface of the drain
warm, the engine oil level reading may be plug with a clean cloth and tighten it se-
in a range between the upper level and curely with a new sealing washer after the
the notch mark. This is caused by thermal B00419 oil has completely drained out.
expansion of the engine oil.
2.5-liter models
Changing the oil and oil filter
Change the oil and oil filter according to
the maintenance schedule in the “Warran-
ty and Maintenance Booklet”.
The engine oil and oil filter must be
changed more frequently than listed in the
maintenance schedule when driving on
dusty roads, when short trips are frequent-
ly made, or when driving in extremely cold
whether. B00420
M
A
Imp qt) or API classification SM with the 2
words “ENERGY CONSERVING” SAE
The oil quantity indicated above is only a 5W-30
guideline. The necessary quantity of oil These recommended oil grades can be
EN
G
depends on the quantity of oil that has identified by looking for either or both of
IN
been drained. The quantity of drained oil the following marks displayed on the oil R
E
differs slightly depending on the tempera- container. GY RV
3 C ONSE
ture of the oil and the time the oil is left B00446
flowing out. After refilling the engine with
oil, therefore, you must use the dipstick to API Service label
1) Indicates the oil quality by API designa-
confirm that the level is correct.
tions
13.Start the engine and make sure that no 2) Indicates the SAE oil viscosity grade
oil leaks appear around the filter’s rubber 3) Indicates that the oil has fuel saving ca-
seal and drain plug. pabilities
14.Run the engine until it reaches the nor-
mal operating temperature. Then stop the In choosing an oil, you want the proper
engine and wait a few minutes to allow the quality and viscosity, as well as one that
oil drain back. Check the oil level again will add to fuel economy. The following ta-
and if necessary, add more engine oil. ble lists the recommended viscosities and
B00014
applicable temperatures.
When adding oil, different brands may be
Recommended grade and ILSAC Certification Mark (Starburst
used together as long as they are the
Mark)
viscosity same API classification and SAE viscosity
as those recommended by SUBARU.
– CONTINUED –
11-14 Maintenance and service
2.5-liter models
1) Drain plug Never attempt to remove the radia- 1
tor cap until the engine has been
shut off and has cooled down com-
pletely. Since the coolant is under
pressure, you may suffer serious B00425
– CONTINUED –
11-16 Maintenance and service
5. Slowly pour the coolant and fill up to y Do not splash the engine coolant
just below the filler neck, allowing enough over painted parts. The alcohol
room to add genuine Subaru cooling sys- contained in the engine coolant
tem conditioner in the radiator. Add genu- may damage the paint surface.
ine Subaru cooling system conditioner un-
til the coolant level reaches the filler neck.
Do not pour the coolant too quickly, as this
may lead to insufficient air bleeding and
trapped air in the system.
– CONTINUED –
11-18 Maintenance and service
B00206 B00201
2. Unplug the connector that is attached 4. Unsnap the two clamps holding the air
to the top of the air cleaner case. cleaner case cover.
At the same time, pull the hose from the
clamp that runs next to the case cover.
B00116
B00207
remove the air cleaner element. Spark plugs Recommended spark plugs
6. Clean the inside of the air cleaner cov-
er and case with a damp cloth and install 2.5-liter non-turbo models:
a new air cleaner element.
FR5AP-11 (NGK)
y When disconnecting the spark 2.5-liter turbo and 3.0-liter models:
plug cables, always grasp the
ILFR6B (NGK)
spark plug cap, not the cables.
y Make sure the cables are replaced
in the correct order.
B00115
2.5-liter models B
0.30 – 0.33 0.35 – 0.40
(7.5 – 8.5) (9.0 – 10.0)
1 2
To check belt tension, place a straight-
edge (ruler) across two adjacent pulleys
B and apply a force of 22 lbs (98 N, 10 kg)
A midway between the pulleys by using a
spring scale. Belt deflection should be the
B00427
amount specified.
Non-turbo models
3.0-liter models 1) Yellow handle
It is unnecessary to check belt tension pe-
3 B00365 riodically because your engine is
equipped with an automatic belt tension
1) Power steering pump pulley adjuster. However, replacement of the
2) Air conditioner compressor pulley belt should be done according to the
3) Crank pulley
maintenance schedule in the “Warranty
and Maintenance Booklet”. Consult your
SUBARU dealer for replacement.
If a belt is loose, cracked, or worn, contact
your SUBARU dealer.
Maintenance and service 11-21
F
1
1 Oil grade:
2
2 API classification GL-5
L
-30 -20 -10 0 10 20 30 40
B00196 B00368
-20 0 20 40 60 80 100
Turbo models 1) Upper level
90
2) Lower level
1. Park the vehicle on a level surface and
stop the engine. 3. Pull out the dipstick again and check 85W
2. Pull out the dipstick, wipe it clean, and the oil level on it. If it is below the lower
insert it again. level, add oil through the dipstick hole to 80W
bring the level up to the upper level.
75W/90
B00032
Be careful not to spill manual trans-
SAE viscosity No. and applicable tem-
mission oil when adding it. If oil perature
touches the exhaust pipe, it may
cause a bad smell, smoke, and/or a
fire. If oil gets on the exhaust pipe,
be sure to wipe it off.
11-22 Maintenance and service
1) Upper level
Use one of the following types of automat- 2) Lower level
ic transmission fluid.
Genuine Subaru Automatic Transmis- 3. Pull out the dipstick again and check
B00430 the oil level on it. If it is below the lower
sion Fluid Type-HP
IDEMITSU ATF HP
1) Yellow handle level, add oil to bring the level up to the up-
Castrol Transmax J per level.
Pennzoil ATF-J* 1. Park the vehicle on a level surface and
* Available only in the USA (except stop the engine.
Alaska and Hawaii)
2. Pull out the dipstick, wipe it clean, and
insert it again. Be careful not to spill front differen-
NOTE tial gear oil when adding it. If oil
Using any non-specified type of auto- touches the exhaust pipe, it may
matic transmission fluid could result in cause a bad smell, smoke, and/or a
damage inside the transmission. When fire. If oil gets on the exhaust pipe,
replacing the automatic transmission be sure to wipe it off.
fluid, be sure to use the kind specified
above.
– CONTINUED –
11-24 Maintenance and service
80W
75W/90
2 B00410
B00032
1
1
3
1
2 2
B00433 2 B00320 B00373
2.5-liter turbo and 3.0-liter models (AT) 2.5-liter turbo and 3.0-liter models (AT) Others
1) Filler plug 1) Filler hole 1) Filler plug
2) Drain plug 2) Drain hole 2) Drain plug
3) Oil level
– CONTINUED –
11-26 Maintenance and service
Power steering fluid y Be careful not to spill power steer- If the fluid level is extreme low, it may indi-
ing fluid when adding it. If power cate possible leakage. Consult your
Checking the fluid level steering fluid touches the exhaust SUBARU dealer for inspection.
pipe, it may cause a bad smell,
smoke, and/or a fire. If power Recommended fluid
steering fluid gets on the exhaust
pipe, be sure to wipe it off. “Dexron III” Type Automatic Transmis-
sion Fluid
The power steering fluid expands greatly
as its temperature rises; the fluid level dif-
fers according to fluid temperature. There-
fore, the reservoir tank has two different
checking ranges for hot and cold fluids.
HOT MAX
COLD MAX Check the power steering fluid level
HOT MIN monthly.
COLD MIN B00124 1. Park the vehicle on a level surface, and
stop the engine.
2. Check the fluid level of the reservoir
tank.
Be careful not to burn yourself be- When the fluid is hot after the vehicle has
cause the fluid may be hot. been run: Check that the oil level is be-
tween “HOT MIN” and “HOT MAX” on the
surface of the reservoir tank.
When the fluid is cool before the vehicle is
y When power steering fluid is be- run: Check that the oil level is between
ing added, use only clean fluid, “COLD MIN” and “COLD MAX” on the sur-
and be careful not to allow any dirt face of the reservoir tank.
into the tank. And never use dif- 3. If the fluid level is lower than the appli-
ferent brands together. cable “MIN” line, add the recommended
y Avoid spilling fluid when adding it fluid as necessary to bring the level be-
in the tank. tween the “MIN” and “MAX” line.
11-28 Maintenance and service
Brake fluid y When adding brake fluid, be care- Use only brake fluid from a sealed con-
ful not to allow any dirt into the tainer.
Checking the fluid level reservoir.
y Never splash the brake fluid over Recommended brake fluid
painted surfaces or rubber parts.
Alcohol contained in the brake flu- FMVSS No. 116, fresh DOT 3 or 4 brake flu-
y Never let brake fluid contact your id may damage them. id
eyes because brake fluid can be
harmful to your eyes. If brake fluid y Be careful not to spill brake fluid
gets in your eyes, immediately when adding it. If brake fluid
flush them thoroughly with clean touches the exhaust pipe, it may
water. For safety, when perform- cause a bad smell, smoke, and/or
ing this work, wearing eye protec- a fire. If brake fluid gets on the ex-
tion is advisable. haust pipe, be sure to wipe it off.
y Brake fluid absorbs moisture from Check the fluid level monthly.
the air. Any absorbed moisture
can cause a dangerous loss of
braking performance.
y If the vehicle requires frequent re-
filling, there may be a leak. If you
suspect a problem, have the vehi-
cle checked at your SUBARU
dealer.
Clutch fluid (MT vehicles) y Never splash the clutch fluid over Recommended clutch fluid
painted surfaces or rubber parts.
Checking the fluid level Alcohol contained in the clutch FMVSS No. 116, fresh DOT 3 or 4 brake flu-
fluid may damage them. id
y Be careful not to spill clutch fluid
when adding it. If clutch fluid
Never let clutch fluid contact your touches the exhaust pipe, it may
eyes because clutch fluid can be cause a bad smell, smoke, and/or Avoid mixing DOT 3 and DOT 4
harmful to your eyes. If clutch fluid a fire. If clutch fluid gets on the ex- brake fluids even if they are of the
gets in your eyes, immediately flush haust pipe, be sure to wipe it off. same brand.
them thoroughly with clean water.
For safety, when performing this
work, wearing eye protection is ad-
visable.
Clutch pedal (Manual trans- Checking the clutch pedal Replacement of brake pad
mission vehicles) free play and lining
Check the clutch pedal free play and re-
serve distance according to the mainte-
nance schedule in the “Warranty and If you continue to drive despite the
Maintenance Booklet”. scraping noise from the audible
brake pad wear indicator, it will re-
Checking the clutch function sult in the need for costly brake ro-
Check the clutch engagement and disen- tor repair or replacement.
gagement. 1
1. With the engine idling, check that there
are no abnormal noises when the clutch
pedal is depressed, and that shifting into B00323
1st or reverse feels smooth.
2. Start the vehicle by releasing the pedal 1) 0.16 – 0.51 in (4.0 – 13.0 mm)
slowly to check that the engine and trans- Lightly press the clutch pedal down with
mission smoothly couple without any sign your finger until you feel resistance, and
of slippage. check the free play.
If the free play is not within proper specifi-
cation, contact your SUBARU dealer.
700040
you apply the brake pedal, have the brake imately 22 mph (35 km/h). Parking brake stroke
pads serviced by your SUBARU dealer as 2. With the parking brake release button
soon as possible. pushed in, pull the parking brake lever
SLOWLY and GENTLY. (Pulling with a
Breaking-in of new brake force of approximately 33 lbs [147 N, 15
kg].)
pads and linings 3. Drive the vehicle for approximately 220
When replacing the brake pad or lining, yards (200 meters) in this condition.
use only genuine SUBARU parts. After re- 4. Wait 5 to 10 minutes for the parking
placement, the new parts must be broken brake to cool down. Repeat this proce-
in as follows: dure.
T Brake pad and lining 5. Check the parking brake stroke. If the
parking brake stroke is out of the specified
While maintaining a speed of 30 to 40 mph range, adjust it by turning the adjusting nut
(50 to 65 km/h), step on the brake pedal located on the parking brake lever. B00127
lightly. Repeat this five or more times.
Check the parking brake stroke according
T Parking brake lining Parking brake stroke:
to the maintenance schedule in the “War-
5 – 6 notches / 44 lbs (196 N, 20 kg) ranty and Maintenance Booklet”. When
the parking brake is properly adjusted,
braking power is fully applied by pulling
A safe location and situation should
the lever up five to six notches gently but
be selected for break-in driving.
firmly (approximately 44 lbs, 196 N, 20
kg). If the parking brake lever stroke is not
within the specified range, have the brake
Pulling the parking brake lever too system checked and adjusted at your
forcefully may cause the rear SUBARU dealer.
wheels to lock. To avoid this, be cer-
tain to pull the lever up slowly and
gently.
1. Drive the vehicle at a speed of approx-
Maintenance and service 11-33
Tires and wheels place all four tires. ery difference of 10°F (5.6°C) between the
temperature in the garage and the tem-
T Winter (snow) tires perature outside. By way of example, the
Types of tires Winter tires are best suited for driving on following table shows the required tire
You should be familiar with type of tires snow-covered and icy roads. However pressures that correspond to various out-
present on your vehicle. winter tires do not perform as well as sum- side temperatures when the temperature
T All season tires mer tires and all season tires on roads oth- in the garage is 60°F (15.6°C).
er than snow-covered and icy roads.
The factory-installed tires on your new ve- Standard tire pressures:
hicle are all season tires. Front: 32 psi (220 kPa, 2.2 kgf/cm2)
All season tires are designed to provide Tire pressure monitoring sys- Rear: 30 psi (210 kPa, 2.1 kgf/cm2)
an adequate measure of traction, handling tem (TPMS) (if equipped) Garage temperature: 60°F (15.6°C)
and braking performance in year-round The tire pressure monitoring system pro-
driving including snowy and icy road con- vides the driver with a warning message Outside Adjusted pressure
ditions. However all season tires do not of- by sending a signal from a sensor that is temperature [psi (kPa, kgf/cm2)]
fer as much traction performance as win- installed in each wheel when tire pressure
ter (snow) tires in heavy or loose snow or is severely low. The tire pressure monitor- front rear
on icy roads. ing system will activate only when the ve- 30°F (–1°C) 35 (240, 2.4) 33 (230, 2.3)
All season tires are identified by “ALL hicle is driven. Also, this system may not
SEASON” and/or “M+S” (Mud & Snow) on react immediately to a sudden drop in tire 10°F (–12°C) 37 35
the tire sidewall. pressure (for example, a blow-out caused (255, 2.55) (245, 2.45)
T Summer tires by running over a sharp object).
–10°F 39 (270, 2.7) 37 (260, 2.6)
Summer tires are high-speed capability If you adjust the tire pressures in a warm (–23°C)
tires best suited for highway driving under garage and will then drive the vehicle in
dry conditions. cold outside air, the resulting drop in tire If the low tire pressure warning light
Summer tires are inadequate for driving pressures may cause the low tire pressure comes on when you drive the vehicle in
on slippery roads such as on snow-cov- warning light to come on. To avoid this cold outside air after adjusting the tire
ered or icy roads. problem when adjusting the tire pressures pressures in a warm garage, re-adjust the
If you drive your vehicle on snow-covered in a warm garage, inflate the tires to pres- tire pressures using the method described
or icy roads, we strongly recommend the sures higher than those shown on the tire above. Then, increase the vehicle speed
use of winter (snow) tires. placard. Specifically, inflate them by an to at least 20 mph (32 km/h) and check to
When installing winter tires, be sure to re- extra 1 psi (6.9 kPa, 0.07 kgf/cm2) for ev- see that the low tire pressure warning light
– CONTINUED –
11-34 Maintenance and service
goes off a few minutes later. If the low tire will not fully function and the warning light If this light still comes on while driv-
pressure warning light does not go off, the in the instrument panel will flash. ing after adjusting the tire pressure,
tire pressure monitoring system may not a tire may have significant damage
be functioning normally. In this event, go When a tire is replaced, adjustments are
necessary to ensure continued normal op- and a fast leak that causes the tire to
to a SUBARU dealer to have the system lose air rapidly. If you have a flat tire,
inspected as soon as possible. eration of the tire pressure monitoring sys-
tem. As with wheel replacement, there- replace it with a spare tire as soon
While the vehicle is driven, friction be- fore, you should have the work performed as possible.
tween tires and the road surface causes by a SUBARU dealer. When a spare tire is mounted or a
the tires to warm up. After illumination of wheel rim is replaced without the
the low tire pressure warning light, any in- original pressure sensor/transmitter
crease in the tire pressures caused by an being transferred, the low tire pres-
increase in the outside air temperature or If the low tire pressure warning light sure warning light will flash. This in-
by an increase in the temperature in the does not come on briefly after the ig- dicates the TPMS is unable to moni-
tires can cause the low tire pressure warn- nition switch is turned ON or the tor all four road wheels. Contact
ing light to go off. light is flashing, you should have your SUBARU dealer as soon as
your Tire Pressure Monitoring Sys- possible for tire and sensor replace-
System resetting is necessary when the tem checked at a SUBARU dealer as ment and/or system resetting. If the
wheels are changed (for example, a soon as possible. light flashes, promptly contact a
switch to snow tires) and new TPMS
If this light comes on while driving, SUBARU dealer to have the system
valves are installed on the newly fitted
never brake suddenly and keep driv- inspected.
wheels. Have this work performed by a
SUBARU dealer following wheel replace- ing straight ahead while gradually
ment. reducing speed. Then slowly pull off Tire inspection
the road to a safe place. Otherwise
Check on a daily basis that the tires are
It may not be possible to install TPMS an accident involving serious vehi-
free from serious damage, nails, and
valves on certain wheels that are on the cle damage and serious personal in-
stones. At the same time, check the tires
market. Therefore, if you change the jury could occur.
for abnormal wear.
wheels (for example, a switch to snow
Contact your SUBARU dealer immediate-
tires), use wheels that have the same part
ly if you find any problem.
number as the standard-equipment
wheels. Without four operational TPMS NOTE
valve/sensors on the wheels, the TPMS y When the wheels and tires strike
Maintenance and service 11-35
– CONTINUED –
11-36 Maintenance and service
y Correct tire pressure (tread worn y Abnormally low tire pressure (tread y Abnormally high tire pressure (tread
evenly) worn at shoulders) worn in center)
Roadholding is good, and steering is re- Rolling resistance is high, so fuel con- Ride comfort is poor. Also, the tire magni-
sponsive. Rolling resistance is low, so fuel sumption is also higher. fies the effects of road-surface bumps and
consumption is also lower. dips, possibly resulting in vehicle damage.
B00054
– CONTINUED –
11-38 Maintenance and service
Tire wear varies from wheel to wheel. To placard and to have a speed symbol and
maximize the life of each tire and ensure load index matching those shown on the
that the tires wear uniformly, it is best to tire placard. y All four tires must be the same in
rotate the tires every 7,500 miles (12,500 terms of manufacturer, brand
km). Rotating the tires involves switching Using tires of a non-specified size detracts
from controllability, ride comfort, braking (tread pattern), construction, de-
the front and rear tires on the right-hand gree of wear, speed symbol, load
side of the vehicle and similarly switching performance, speedometer accuracy and
odometer accuracy. It also creates incor- index and size. Mixing tires of dif-
the front and rear tires on the left-hand ferent types, sizes or degrees of
side of the vehicle. (Each tire must be kept rect body-to-tire clearances and inappro-
priately changes the vehicle’s ground wear can result in damage to the
on its original side of the vehicle.) vehicle’s power train. Use of dif-
Replace any damaged or unevenly worn clearance.
ferent types or sizes of tires can
tire at the time of rotation. After tire rota- All four tires must be the same in terms of also dangerously reduce control-
tion, adjust the tire pressures and make manufacturer, brand (tread pattern), con- lability and braking performance
sure the wheel nuts are correctly tight- struction, and size. You are advised to re- and can lead to an accident.
ened. place the tires with new ones that are
y Use only radial tires. Do not use
After driving approximately 600 miles identical to those fitted as standard equip-
radial tires together with belted
(1,000 km), check the wheel nuts again ment.
bias tires and/or bias-ply tires. Do-
and retighten any nut that has become For safe vehicle operation, SUBARU rec- ing so can dangerously reduce
loose. ommends replacing all four tires at the controllability, resulting in an ac-
same time. cident.
Tire replacement
The wheels and tires are important and in- Wheel replacement
tegral parts of your vehicle’s design; they When replacing wheels due, for example,
cannot be changed arbitrarily. The tires fit- to damage, make sure the replacement
ted as standard equipment are optimally wheels match the specifications of the
matched to the characteristics of the vehi- wheels that are fitted as standard equip-
cle and were selected to give the best pos- ment. Replacement wheels are available
sible combination of running performance, from SUBARU dealers.
ride comfort, and service life. It is essential
for every tire to have a size and construc-
tion matching those shown on the tire
Maintenance and service 11-39
– CONTINUED –
11-40 Maintenance and service
id until it reaches the “Hi” level on the level perature, it may freeze and block the noz-
gauge or the “Full” mark on the tank. zles.
Use windshield washer fluid. If windshield
washer fluid is unavailable use clean wa-
ter.
In areas where water freezes in winter, Adjust the washer fluid concentra-
use an anti-freeze type windshield washer tion appropriately for the outside
fluid. SUBARU Windshield Washer Fluid temperature. If the concentration is
Hi inappropriate, sprayed washer fluid
contains 58.5% methyl alcohol and 41.5%
surfactant, by volume. Its freezing temper- may freeze on the windshield and
ature varies according to how much it is di- obstruct your view, and the fluid
Low luted, as indicated in the following table. may freeze in the reservoir tank.
300172
– CONTINUED –
11-42 Maintenance and service
Windshield wiper blade rub- 3. Align the claws of the metal support
ber with the grooves in the rubber and slide
the blade rubber assembly into the metal
support until it locks.
1
B00504
1) Metal spines
B00330 1
2. If the new blade rubber is not provided
B00332
1) Metal support with two metal spines, remove the metal
spines from the old blade rubber and in- 1) Stopper
1. Grasp the locked end of the blade rub- stall them in the new blade rubber.
ber assembly and pull it firmly until the 4. Be sure to position the claws at the end
stoppers on the rubber are free of the met- of the metal support between the stoppers
al support. on the rubber as shown. If the rubber is
not retained properly, the wiper blade may
scratch the windshield.
B00059
Maintenance and service 11-43
Rear window wiper blade rub- 2. Pull the blade rubber assembly out of
ber the plastic support.
1
700063
700064
– CONTINUED –
11-44 Maintenance and service
y To lessen the risk of sparks, re- battery fluid level or periodically refill with Fuses
move rings, metal watchbands, distilled water.
and other metal jewelry. Never al-
low metal tools to contact the pos-
itive battery terminal and anything Never replace a fuse with one hav-
connected to it WHILE you are at ing a higher rating or with material
the same time in contact with any other than a fuse because serious
other metallic portion of the vehi- damage or a fire could result.
cle because a short circuit will re-
sult.
y Keep everyone including children
away from the battery.
y Charge the battery in a well-venti-
lated area.
y Battery posts, terminals, and re-
lated accessories contain lead
and lead compounds, chemicals
known to the State of California to
cause cancer and reproductive
harm. Batteries also contain other B00130
chemicals known to the State of
California to cause cancer. Wash The fuses are designed to melt during an
hands after handling. overload to prevent damage to the wiring
harness and electrical equipment. The
fuses are located in two fuse boxes. One
is located under the instrument panel be-
Never use more than 10 amperes hind the fuse box cover on the driver’s
when charging the battery because seat side.
it will shorten battery life.
It is unnecessary to periodically check the
– CONTINUED –
11-46 Maintenance and service
1 2
Open the lid that is located above the The spare fuses are stored in the main 1) Good
hood release knob and pull it toward you fuse box cover in the engine compart- 2) Blown
to remove it. ment.
If any lights, accessories or other electri-
cal controls do not operate, inspect the
corresponding fuse. If a fuse has blown,
replace it.
1. Turn the ignition switch to the “LOCK”
position and turn off all electrical accesso-
ries.
2. Remove the cover.
3. Determine which fuse may be blown.
The back side of each fuse box cover and
the “Fuses and circuits” section in chapter
12 in this manual show the circuit for each
600120 600159 fuse.
The other one is housed in the engine The fuse puller is stored in the main fuse
compartment. box in the engine compartment.
Maintenance and service 11-47
600160
Replacing bulbs
8 9 10
1 2 3 4 5
13 14
18 11 12
7 6 17 18 17 16 15
B00435
Maintenance and service 11-49
– CONTINUED –
11-50 Maintenance and service
T Low beam light bulbs 4. Replace the bulb, then set the retainer Parking light
spring securely. It may be difficult to replace the bulbs.
5. Reconnect the electrical connector. Have your SUBARU dealer replace the
6. Install the bulb cover. bulbs if necessary.
T High beam light bulbs
Front turn signal light
It may be difficult to replace the bulbs.
Have your SUBARU dealer replace the
bulbs if necessary.
700069
T Sedan
1
3
B00437
B00134
1) Rear turn signal light
2) Backup light
B00436
3) Brake/tail and rear side marker light
1. Using a Phillips screwdriver, remove
the upper and lower screws.
1. Push the knobs of the cover to open 2. Remove the bulb holder from the rear
the cover. combination light assembly by turning it 3
counterclockwise.
3. Pull the bulb out of the bulb holder and 1
replace it with a new one.
4. Set the bulb holder into the rear combi-
nation light assembly and turn it clockwise
until it locks. 2
5. Securely lock the cover against the
trunk trim by using the screwdriver to turn
the top knob clockwise.
B00438
– CONTINUED –
11-52 Maintenance and service
gap A between the side cover and rear Backup light (Station wagon)
combination lamp and use it as a lever to
undo the clip. Undo clips C and D in the
same way, then remove the side cover.
3
1
2
B00439
B00139
Dome light
700075 700076
3. Pull the bulb out of the bulb socket and 1. Remove the mounting screws using a
replace it with a new one. Phillips screwdriver.
4. Install the bulb socket by turning it 2. Remove the lens.
clockwise. Install the light cover on the 700083
rear gate.
1. Remove the lens by prying the edge of
the lens with a flat-head screwdriver.
License plate light
T Sedan
It may be difficult to replace the bulbs.
Have your SUBARU dealer replace the
bulbs if necessary.
700077
– CONTINUED –
11-54 Maintenance and service
700084
its ends are aligned vertically. Pull the 1. Remove the lens by prying the edge of
bulb straight downward to remove it. In- the lens with a flat-head screwdriver.
stall a new bulb.
3. Reinstall the lens. 700081
700086
700082 700079
2. Pull the bulb out of the socket. Install a 3. Pull the bulb out of the socket. Install a
new bulb. 700078 new bulb.
3. Reinstall the lens. 4. Reinstall the lens.
1. Remove the cargo area light assembly
by prying the edge of the light with a flat-
head screwdriver. Trunk light (Sedan)
2. Remove the lens from the cargo area
light assembly.
700080
– CONTINUED –
11-56 Maintenance and service
12
12-2 Specifications
Specifications
Specifications
Dimensions
in (mm)
Item Legacy OUTBACK
Sedan Station wagon Sedan Station wagon
Non- Turbo
turbo
2.5-liter 3.0-liter 2.5-liter 3.0-liter
Non- Turbo
turbo
Overall length 186.2 (4,730) 188.8 (4,795) 186.2 (4,730) 188.8 (4,795)
Overall width 68.1 (1,730) 68.1 (1,730) 69.7 (1,770) 69.7 (1,770)
Overall height 56.1 (1,425) 58.1 (1,475) 59.6 (1,515) 63.2 (1,605)
Wheel base 105.1 (2,670) 105.1 (2,670) 105.1 (2,670) 105.1 (2,670)
Tread Front 58.9 (1,495) 58.9 (1,495) 58.9 (1,495) 58.9 (1,495)
Rear 58.5 (1,485) 58.5 (1,485) 58.7 (1,490) 58.7 (1,490)
Ground clearance 5.9 (150) 5.9 6.1 8.44 (214.6) 8.5 8.7 8.5 (215)
(150) (155) (215) (220)
Specifications 12-3
Engine
Engine model EJ253 EJ255 EZ30D
(2.5-liter, SOHC, non-turbo) (2.5-liter, DOHC, turbo) (3.0-liter, DOHC, non-turbo)
Engine type Horizontally opposed, liquid cooled 4 cylinder, Horizontally opposed, liquid cooled 6 cylinder,
4 stroke gasoline engine 4 stroke gasoline engine
Displacement cu-in (cc) 150 (2,457) 183 (3,000)
Bore × Stroke in (mm) 3.92 × 3.11 (99.5 × 79.0) 3.51 × 3.15 (89.2 × 80.0)
Compression ratio 10.0 : 1 8.2 : 1 10.7 : 1
Firing order 1–3–2–4 1–6–3–2–5–4
Electrical system
Battery type and capacity (5HR) 2.5-liter models MT 55D23L (12V-48AH)
AT 75D23L (12V-52AH)
3.0-liter models 75D23L (12V-52AH)
Alternator 12V-110A
Spark plugs 2.5-liter non-turbo models FR5AP-11 (NGK)
2.5-liter turbo and 3.0-liter models ILFR6B (NGK)
– CONTINUED –
12-4 Specifications
Capacities
Fuel tank 16.9 US gal (64 liters, 14.1 Imp gal)
Engine oil 2.5-liter models 4.2 US qt (4.0 liters, 3.5 Imp qt)
3.0-liter models 5.8 US qt (5.5 liters, 4.8 Imp qt)
Transmission oil (MT) 3.7 US qt (3.5 liters, 3.1 Imp qt)
Transmission fluid (AT) 2.5-liter non-turbo models 9.8 US qt (9.3 liters, 8.2 Imp qt)
2.5-liter turbo and 3.0-liter models 10.4 US qt (9.8 liters, 8.6 Imp qt)
AT differential gear oil 2.5-liter non-turbo models 1.3 US qt (1.2 liters, 1.1 Imp qt)
2.5-liter turbo and 3.0-liter models 1.5 US qt (1.4 liters, 1.2 Imp qt)
Rear differential gear oil 0.8 US qt (0.8 liter, 0.7 Imp qt)
Power steering fluid 0.7 US qt (0.7 liter, 0.6 Imp qt)
Engine coolant 2.5-liter non-turbo models MT 6.8 US qt (6.4 liters, 5.6 Imp qt)
AT 6.7 US qt (6.3 liters, 5.5 Imp qt)
2.5-liter turbo models MT 7.7 US qt (7.3 liters, 6.4 Imp qt)
AT 7.6 US qt (7.2 liters, 6.3 Imp qt)
3.0-liter models 7.6 US qt (7.2 liters, 6.3 Imp qt)
Specifications 12-5
Tires
Tire size P205/50R17 88V 215/45ZR17 P225/55R17 95V
Wheel size 17 × 7 JJ
Pressure Front 33 psi (230 kPa, 2.3 kgf/cm2) 35 psi (240 kPa, 2.4 kgf/cm2) 32 psi (220 kPa, 2.2 kgf/cm2)
Rear 32 psi (220 kPa, 2.2 kgf/cm2) 33 psi (230 kPa, 2.3 kgf/cm2) 30 psi (210 kPa, 2.1 kgf/cm2)
Rear at trailer – 32 psi (220 kPa, 2.2 kgf/cm2)
towing
Temporary Size T135/80R16 T135/70D17 T155/70D17
spare tire Pressure 60 psi (420 kPa, 4.2 kgf/cm2)
Wheel alignment
Item Legacy OUTBACK
Sedan Station wagon Sedan Station wagon
Toe Front 0 in (0 mm)
Rear 0 in (0 mm)
Camber Front –0°15’ 0°40’
Rear –0°40’ –0°30’ –0°10’
12-6 Specifications
Fuse panel Fuse rating Circuit Fuse panel Fuse rating Circuit
– CONTINUED –
12-8 Specifications
3
5 20A y Audio
4 5 6 7
6 15A y Headlight (right side)
7 15A y Headlight (left side)
8
8 20A y Backup light
9 15A y Horn
10 25A y Rear window defogger
11 12 13 14
12 15A y Automatic transmission control unit
A 15 16
6 5
7
C00104
Consumer information and Reporting safety defects
13
13-2 Consumer information and Reporting safety defects
– CONTINUED –
13-4 Consumer information and Reporting safety defects
– CONTINUED –
13-6 Consumer information and Reporting safety defects
T Vehicle placard The vehicle placard shows original are affected by the outside tempera-
tire size, recommended cold tire infla- ture. It is best to check tire pressure
tion pressure on each tire at maxi- outdoors before driving the vehicle.
mum loaded vehicle weight, seating When a tire becomes warm, the air in-
capacity and loading information. side it expands, causing the tire pres-
sure to increase. Be careful not to
T Adverse safety consequences
mistakenly release air from a warm
of under-inflation tire to reduce its pressure.
Driving at high speeds with exces-
sively low tire pressures can cause Glossary of tire terminology
the tires to flex severely and to rapidly
become hot. A sharp increase in tem- y Cold tire pressure
B00128 perature could cause tread separa- The pressure in a tire that has been
tion, and failure of the tire(s). Possi- driven less than 1 mile or has been
The vehicle placard is affixed to the standing for three hours or more.
ble resulting loss of vehicle control
driver’s side B-pillar. could lead to an accident. y Maximum inflation pressure
Example: The maximum cold inflation pressure
T Measuring and adjusting air to which a tire may be inflated.
pressure to achieve proper infla- y Recommended inflation pres-
TIRE AND LOADING INFORMATION tion sure
SEATING CAPACITY TOTAL 5 FRONT 2 REAR 3 Check and, if necessary, adjust the The cold inflation pressure recom-
The combined weight of occupants and cargo
should never exceed 385kg or 850lbs.
pressure of each tire (including the mended by a vehicle manufacturer.
COLD TIRE
spare) at least once a month and be- y Intended outboard sidewall
TIRE SISE
PRESSURE
fore any long journey. Check the tire 1)The sidewall that contains a
FRONT P205/50R17 230KPA.33PSI
SEE OWNER’S
MANUAL FOR pressures when the tires are cold. whitewall, bears white lettering or
ADDITIONAL
REAR P205/50R17 220KPA.32PSI
INFORMATION Use a pressure gauge to adjust the bears manufacturer, brand, and/or
tire pressures to the specific values. model name molding that is higher
SF
asymmetrical tire that has a particu- weighing over 5.1 lbs (2.3 kg) in ex- wear indicators become visible. When
lar side that must always face out- cess of those standards items which a tire’s tread wear indicator becomes
ward when mounting on a vehicle. they replace, not previously consid- visible, the tire is worn beyond the ac-
y Accessory weight ered in curb weight or accessory ceptable limit and must be replaced
The combined weight (in excess of weight. immediately. With a tire in this condi-
those standard items which may be y Vehicle capacity weight tion, driving at even low speeds in wet
replaced) of floor mats, leather seats The total weight of cargo, luggage weather can cause the vehicle to hy-
and cross bars to the extent that these and occupants that can be added to droplane. Possible resulting loss of
items are available as factory-in- the vehicle. vehicle control can lead to an acci-
stalled equipment (whether installed y Vehicle maximum load on a tire dent.
or not). Load on an individual tire that is deter- y To maximize the life of each tire and
y Curb weight mined by distributing to each axle its ensure that the tires wear uniformly, it
The weight of a motor vehicle with share of the maximum loaded vehicle is best to rotate the tires every 7,500
standard equipment including the weight and dividing by two. miles (12,500 km). Rotating the tires
maximum capacity of fuel, oil, and y Vehicle normal load on a tire involves switching the front and rear
coolant and air conditioning. Load on an individual tire that is deter- tires on the right-hand side of the ve-
y Maximum loaded vehicle weight mined by distributing to each axle its hicle and similarly switching the front
The sum of curb weight, accessory share of the curb weight, accessory and rear tires on the left-hand side of
weight, vehicle capacity weight and weight, and normal occupant weight the vehicle. (Each tire must be kept on
production options weight. and dividing by two. its original side of the vehicle.) Re-
y Normal occupant weight place any damaged or unevenly worn
150 lbs (68 kg) times the number of Tire care – maintenance and tire at the time of rotation. After tire ro-
occupants (3 occupants). safety practices tation, adjust the tire pressures and
y Occupant distribution make sure the wheel nuts are correct-
y Check on a daily basis that the tires
Distribution of occupants in a vehicle, are free from serious damage, nails,
ly tightened. A tightening torque spec-
2 in front, 1 in rear seat. ification and a tightening sequence
and stones. At the same time, check
y Production options weight specification for the wheel nuts can be
the tires for abnormal wear.
The combined weight of those in- y Inspect the tire tread regularly and
found “Flat tires” section in chapter 9.
stalled regular production options
replace the tires before their tread
– CONTINUED –
13-8 Consumer information and Reporting safety defects
Vehicle load limit – how to de- T Calculating total and load capac- 1. Calculate the total weight.
termine ities varying seating configura-
The load capacity of your vehicle is tions Total weight
determined by weight, not by avail- Calculate the available load capacity = 154 lbs (70 kg) + 551 lbs (250 kg)
able cargo space. The load limit of as shown in the following examples: (Occupant) (Cargo)
your vehicle is shown on the vehicle Example 1A = 705 lbs (320 kg)
placard attached to the driver’s side
B-pillar. Locate the statement “The 2. Calculate the available load capac-
combined weight of occupants and ity by subtracting the total weight from
cargo should never exceed XXX kg or the vehicle capacity weight of 800 lbs
XXX lbs” on your vehicle’s placard. (363 kg).
The vehicle placard also shows seat-
ing capacity of your vehicle. Available Load Capacity
The total load capacity includes the
total weight of driver and all passen- = 800 lbs (363 kg) 705 lbs (320 kg)
gers and their belongings, any cargo, (Vehicle (Total weight)
any optional equipment such as a capacity weight)
trailer hitch, roof rack or bike carrier, D00111
= 95 lbs (43 kg)
etc., and the tongue load of a trailer.
Vehicle capacity weight of the vehicle
Therefore cargo capacity can be cal- 3. The result of step 2 shows that a
is 800 lbs (363 kg), which is indicated
culated by the following method. further 95 lbs (43 kg) of cargo can be
on the vehicle placard with the state-
carried.
Cargo capacity = Load limit – (total ment “The combined weight of occu-
weight of occupants + total weight of pants and cargo should never exceed
optional equipment + tongue load of a 363 kg or 800 lbs”.
trailer (if applicable))
For example, if the vehicle has one
For towing capacity information and occupant weighing 154 lbs (70 kg)
weight limits, refer to “Trailer towing” plus cargo weighing 551 lbs (250 kg).
section in chapter 8.
Consumer information and Reporting safety defects 13-9
Example 1B 2. Calculate the available load capac- on the vehicle placard with the state-
ity. ment “The combined weight of occu-
pants and cargo should never exceed
Available Load Capacity 363 kg or 800 lbs”.
= 800 lbs (363 kg) 881 lbs (400 kg) For example, the vehicle has one oc-
(Vehicle (Total weight) cupant weighing 165 lbs (75 kg) plus
capacity weight) cargo weighing 265 lbs (120 kg). In
addition, the vehicle is fitted with a
= 81 lbs ( 37 kg)
trailer hitch weighing 22 lbs (10 kg), to
3. The total weight now exceeds the which is attached a trailer weighing
capacity weight by 81 lbs (37 kg), so 1,764 lbs (800 kg). 10% of the trailer
D00112
the cargo weight must be reduced by weight is applied to the trailer tongue
81 lbs (37 kg) or more. (i.e. Tongue load = 176 lbs (80 kg)).
For example, if a person weighing 176
lbs (80 kg) now enters the same vehi- Example 2A 1. Calculate the total weight.
cle (bringing the number of occupants
to two), the calculations are as fol- Total weight
lows:
= 165 lbs (75 kg) + 265 lbs (120 kg)
1. Calculate the total weight. (Occupant) (Cargo)
weighing 11 lbs (5 kg) is installed in 3. The total weight now exceeds the
Available Load Capacity
the vehicle for the child to use, the cal- capacity weight by 22 lbs (10 kg), so
= 800 lbs (363 kg) 628 lbs (285 kg) culations are as follows: the cargo weight must be reduced by
(Vehicle (Total weight) 22 lbs (10 kg) or more.
capacity weight) 1. Calculate the total weight.
also loaded capacities of the vehicle’s Steps for Determining Cor- ferred to your vehicle. Consult this
suspension, axles and other parts of rect Load Limit manual to determine how this reduc-
the body. 1. Locate the statement “The com- es the available cargo and luggage
Therefore, this means that the vehicle bined weight of occupants and cargo load capacity of your vehicle.
cannot necessarily be loaded up to should never exceed XXX pounds” on
the tire’s maximum load rating on the your vehicle’s placard.
tire sidewall. 2. Determine the combined weight of
the driver and passengers that will be
Adverse safety consequenc- riding in your vehicle.
es of overloading on handling 3. Subtract the combined weight of
and stopping and on tires the driver and passengers from XXX
Overloading could affect vehicle han- kilograms or XXX pounds.
dling, stopping distance, vehicle and 4. The resulting figure equals the
tire as shown in the following. This available amount of cargo and lug-
could lead to an accident and possibly gage load capacity. For example, if
result in severe personal injury. the “XXX” amount equals 1,400 lbs
y Vehicle stability will deteriorate. (635kg). and there will be five- 150 lbs
y Heavy and/or high-mounted loads (68 kg) passengers in your vehicle,
could increase the risk of rollover. the amount of available cargo and
y Stopping distance will increase. luggage load capacity is 650 lbs.
y Brakes could overheat and fail. (1,400 – 750 (5 × 150) = 650 lbs.)
y Suspension, bearings, axles and 5. Determine the combined weight of
other parts of the body could break or luggage and cargo being loaded on
experience accelerated wear that will the vehicle. That weight may not safe-
shorten vehicle life. ly exceed the available cargo and lug-
y Tires could fail. gage load capacity calculated in Step
y Tread separation could occur. 4.
y Tire could separate from its rim. 6. If your vehicle will be towing a trail-
er, load from your trailer will be trans-
13-12 Consumer information and Reporting safety defects
14
14-2 Index
Snowy and icy roads ..................................................... 8-9 Seatbelt pretensioners ................................................. 1-21
Tips ..................................................... 7-11, 7-16, 7-23, 8-5 Seats .............................................................................. 1-2
Tired or sleepy ................................................................... 7 Fuel ..................................................................................... 7-2
Economy hints ............................................................... 8-2
E Filler lid and cap ............................................................. 7-4
Electrical system .............................................................. 12-3 Gauge ................................................................... 3-8, 3-12
Electronic Brake Force Distribution (EBD) system ........... 7-28 Requirements ................................................................ 7-2
Emergency Locking Retractor (ELR) ................................ 1-12 Fuses .............................................................................. 11-45
Engine Fuses and circuits ............................................................. 12-6
Compartment overview ................................................ 11-6
Coolant ...................................................................... 11-14 G
Exhaust gas (Carbon monoxide) ................................... 8-2 GAWR (Gross Axle Weight Rating) .................................. 8-14
Hood ............................................................................ 11-4 Glove box ........................................................................... 6-4
Oil ................................................................................ 11-9 GVWR (Gross Vehicle Weight Rating) ............................. 8-14
Overheating ................................................................. 9-12
Starting .......................................................................... 7-8 H
Stopping ........................................................................ 7-9 Hazard warning flasher ....................................................... 3-5
Exterior care ..................................................................... 10-2 Head restraint adjustment (Front) ....................................... 1-5
Headlight
F Flasher ......................................................................... 3-32
Flat tires ............................................................................. 9-4 Indicator light ............................................................... 3-25
Floor mat .......................................................................... 6-12 Headlights .............................................................. 3-31, 11-49
Fluid level Heater operation ................................................................. 4-5
Automatic transmission ............................................. 11-22 High beam indicator light .................................................. 3-25
Brake ......................................................................... 11-28 High mount stop light ...................................................... 11-56
Clutch ........................................................................ 11-29 Horn .................................................................................. 3-43
Power steering ........................................................... 11-27 Hose and connections .................................................... 11-14
Fog light switch ................................................................. 3-34
Front I
Differential gear oil ..................................................... 11-23 Ignition switch ..................................................................... 3-3
Fog light ..................................................................... 11-50 Light ............................................................................... 3-5
Index 14-5
N R
New vehicle break-in driving the first 1,000 miles Rear
(1,600 km) ...................................................................... 8-2 Combination lights ..................................................... 11-51
Differential gear oil ..................................................... 11-24
O Gate ............................................................................. 2-24
Odometer .................................................................. 3-7, 3-11 Seats .............................................................................. 1-7
Off road driving ................................................................... 8-6 Rear seat
Oil filter ........................................................................... 11-10 Folding down (Station wagon) ....................................... 1-8
Oil level Rear window
Engine ......................................................................... 11-9 Defogger button ........................................................... 3-38
Front differential gear (AT vehicles) .......................... 11-23 Wiper and washer switch ............................................. 3-37
Manual transmission .................................................. 11-20 Recommended
Rear differential ......................................................... 11-24 Automatic transmission fluid ...................................... 11-23
Oil pressure warning light ................................................. 3-18 Brake fluid .................................................................. 11-28
Outside mirrors ................................................................. 3-41 Clutch fluid ................................................................. 11-29
Outside temperature indicator .......................................... 3-27 OIL grade and viscosity ...................... 11-12, 11-13, 11-21,
Overheating engine .......................................................... 9-12 11-24, 11-26
Power steering fluid ................................................... 11-27
Spark plugs ................................................................ 11-19
P Remote keyless entry system ............................................. 2-7
Parking Replacement
Brake stroke .............................................................. 11-32 Brake pad and lining .................................................. 11-31
Light switch .................................................................. 3-33 Wiper blades .............................................................. 11-41
Periodic inspection ............................................................. 8-4 Replacing
Power Air cleaner element .................................................... 11-17
Door locking switches .................................................... 2-6 Battery (remote keyless entry system) ........................... 2-7
Seat ............................................................................... 1-4 Lost transmitters (keyless entry system) ...................... 2-11
Steering fluid ............................................................. 11-27 Replacing bulbs .............................................................. 11-48
Windows ...................................................................... 2-19 Cargo area light ......................................................... 11-55
Precautions against vehicle modification ................ 1-24, 1-61 Dome light .................................................................. 11-53
Preparing to drive ............................................................... 7-7 Door step light ............................................................ 11-54
Printed antenna .................................................................. 5-2 Front fog light ............................................................. 11-50
Index 14-7
Front turn signal light ................................................. 11-50 Speedometer ............................................................. 3-6, 3-10
Headlight ................................................................... 11-49 SRS
High mount stop light ................................................. 11-56 Curtain airbag .............................................................. 1-53
License plate light ...................................................... 11-53 Frontal airbag ............................................................... 1-43
Map light .................................................................... 11-54 Side airbag ................................................................... 1-53
Parking light ............................................................... 11-50 SRS airbag (Supplemental Restraint System
Rear combination light ............................................... 11-51 airbag) ....................................................................... 4, 1-38
Trunk light .................................................................. 11-55 SRS airbag system warning light ...................................... 3-16
Rocking the vehicle .......................................................... 8-12 Starting the engine .............................................................. 7-8
Roof rail and crossbar ...................................................... 8-14 State emission testing (U.S. only) ....................................... 7-6
Steering wheel
S Power ........................................................................... 7-25
Safety Tilt ................................................................................ 3-43
Precautions when driving ................................................. 4 Stopping the engine ............................................................ 7-9
Symbol .............................................................................. 2 Storage compartment ......................................................... 6-4
Warnings .......................................................................... 2 Sun shades ....................................................................... 2-27
Seat Sun visors ........................................................................... 6-3
Fabric ........................................................................... 10-5 Supplemental Restraint System airbag (SRS) .................. 1-38
Heater ............................................................................ 1-7 Synthetic leather upholstery ............................................. 10-5
Seatbelt ................................................................................. 4
Maintenance ................................................................ 1-21 T
Pretensioners .............................................................. 1-21 Tachometer ................................................................ 3-8, 3-12
Safety tips .................................................................... 1-11 Temperature gauge ................................................... 3-9, 3-13
Warning light and chime .............................................. 1-13 Temperature warning light (AT OIL TEMP) ...................... 3-18
Seatbelts .......................................................................... 1-11 Temporary spare tire .......................................................... 9-2
Selector lever .......................................................... 7-12, 7-18 Tie-down hooks ................................................................ 9-13
Position indicator ......................................................... 3-24 Tilt steering wheel ............................................................. 3-43
Shift lock release ..................................................... 7-16, 7-23 Tire
Snow tires ......................................................................... 8-10 Chains .......................................................................... 8-11
Sounding a panic alarm .................................................... 2-10 Inspection ................................................................... 11-34
Spark plugs .................................................................... 11-19 Pressures and wear ................................................... 11-35
Specifications ................................................................... 12-2 Replacement .............................................................. 11-38
14-8 Index
13
12
4
11
10
5
9
7 8
6 000134
GAS STATION REFERENCE
Fuel: tor Octane numbers and is commonly referred to as the Anti Knock
Index (AKI). Refer to “Fuel” section in this manual.
T 2.5-liter non-turbo models
Use only unleaded gasoline with an octane rating of 87 AKI or Fuel capacity:
higher.
16.9 US gal (64 liters, 14.1 Imp gal)
T 2.5-liter turbo models and 3.0-liter models
Use premium unleaded gasoline with an octane rating of 91 AKI or Engine oil:
higher. For temporary purposes if premium unleaded gasoline is
not available, you may use regular unleaded gasoline with an oc- Use only API classification SM with the words “ENERGY CON-
tane rating of 87 AKI or higher. For optimum engine performance SERVING” and the ILSAC certification mark (starburst mark) dis-
and driveability, it is required (for 2.5-liter turbo models), and rec- played on the container.
ommended (for 3.0-liter models) that you use premium grade un-
leaded gasoline. Engine oil capacity:
Fuel octane rating 2.5-liter models: 4.2 US qt (4.0 liters, 3.5 Imp qt)
3.0-liter models: 5.8 US qt (5.5 liters, 4.8 Imp qt)
This octane rating is the average of the Research Octane and Mo-